2006 Accord

User Manual: 2006-accord

Open the PDF directly: View PDF PDF.
Page Count: 292

Download2006-accord
Open PDF In BrowserView PDF
2006 Accord Sedan Online Reference Owner's Manual
Use these links (and links throughout this manual) to navigate through this reference.
For a printed owner's manual, click on authorized manuals or go to www.helminc.com.

Contents
Owner's Identification Form
Introduction ......................................................................................................................................... i
A Few Words About Safety................................................................................................................. ii
Your Vehicle at a Glance..................................................................................................................... 4
Driver and Passenger Safety .............................................................................................................. 7
Proper use and care of your vehicle's seat belts, and Supplemental Restraint System.
Instruments and Controls................................................................................................................. 55
Instrument panel indicator and gauge, and how to use dashboard and steering column controls.
Comfort and Convenience Features .............................................................................................. 101
How to operate the climate control system, the audio system, and other convenience features.
Before Driving.................................................................................................................................. 153
What gasoline to use, how to break-in your new vehicle, and how to load luggage and other cargo.
Driving .............................................................................................................................................. 167
The proper way to start the engine, shift the transmission, and park, plus towing a trailer.
Maintenance ..................................................................................................................................... 191
The Maintenance Schedule shows you when you need to take your vehicle to the dealer.
Taking Care of the Unexpected ...................................................................................................... 237
This section covers several problems motorists sometimes experience, and how to handle them.
Technical Information..................................................................................................................... 263
ID numbers, dimensions, capacities, and technical information.
Warranty and Customer Relations (U.S. and Canada) ................................................................ 277
A summary of the warranties covering your new Acura, and how to contact us.
Authorized Manuals (U.S. only)...................................................................................................... 281
How to order manuals and other technical literature.
Index...................................................................................................................................................... I
Service Information Summary
A summary of information you need when you pull up to the fuel pump.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Accord Value Package Audio System

05/06/03

09:24:35

31SDA630

0001

Owner’s Identification
This owner’s manual should be considered
a permanent part of the vehicle and should
remain with the vehicle when it is sold.

OWNER

This owner’s manual covers all models of
the Accord Sedan. You may find
descriptions of equipment and features that
are not on your particular model.

ADDRESS
STREET

CITY

STATE/PROVINCE

ZIP CODE/
POSTAL CODE

V. I. N.
DELIVERY DATE

The information and specifications included
in this publication were in effect at the time
of approval for printing. Honda Motor Co.,
Ltd. reserves the right, however, to
discontinue or change specifications or
design at any time without notice and
without incurring any obligation whatsoever.

(Date sold to original retail purchaser)

DEALER NAME

DEALER NO.

ADDRESS
STREET

CITY

STATE/PROVINCE

ZIP CODE/
POSTAL CODE

OWNER’S SIGNATURE
DEALER’S SIGNATURE

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

POUR CLIENTS CANADIEN
AVIS IMPORTANT: Si vous avez
besoin d’un Manuel du Conducteur en
français, veuillez demander à votre
concessionnaire de commander le
numéro de pièce 33SDAC30 .

05/06/03

09:24:41

31SDA630

0002

Introduction
Congratulations! Your selection of a 2006 Honda Accord was a wise
investment. It will give you years of driving pleasure.
One of the best ways to enhance the enjoyment of your new Honda is to
read this manual. In it, you will learn how to operate its driving controls and
convenience items. Afterwards, keep this owner’s manual in your vehicle so
you can refer to it at any time.

As you read this manual, you will
find information that is preceded by
a
symbol. This
information is intended to help you
avoid damage to your Honda, other
property, or the environment.
California Proposition 65 Warning

Several warranties protect your new vehicle. Read the warranty booklet
thoroughly so you understand the coverages and are aware of your rights
and responsibilities.
Maintaining your vehicle according to the maintenance minder shown in the
instrument panel helps to keep your driving trouble-free while it preserves
your investment. When your vehicle needs maintenance, keep in mind that
your dealer’s staff is specially trained in servicing the many systems unique
to your vehicle. Your Honda dealer is dedicated to your satisfaction and will
be pleased to answer any questions and concerns.

WARNING: This product contains
or emits chemicals known to the
state of California to cause cancer
and birth defects or other
reproductive harm.
Event Data Recorders
This vehicle is equipped with one or
more recording devices commonly
referred to as event data recorders
or sensing and diagnostic modules.

i

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/06/03

09:24:52

31SDA630

0003

A Few Words About Safety
Your safety, and the safety of others,
is very important. And operating this
vehicle safely is an important
responsibility.
To help you make informed
decisions about safety, we have
provided operating procedures and
other information on labels and in
this manual. This information alerts
you to potential hazards that could
hurt you or others.
Of course, it is not practical or
possible to warn you about all the
hazards associated with operating or
maintaining your vehicle. You must
use your own good judgement.

You will find this important safety information in a variety of forms,
including:
Safety Labels − on the vehicle.
Safety Messages − preceded by a safety alert symbol
and one of
three signal words: DANGER, WARNING, or CAUTION.
These signal words mean:
You WILL be KILLED or SERIOUSLY
HURT if you don’t follow instructions.
You CAN be KILLED or SERIOUSLY
HURT if you don’t follow instructions.
You CAN be HURT if you don’t follow
instructions.
Safety Headings − such as Important Safety Reminders or Important
Safety Precautions.
Safety Section − such as Driver and Passenger Safety.
Instructions − how to use this vehicle correctly and safely.
This entire book is filled with important safety information − please read it
carefully.

ii

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/06/03

09:25:26

31SDA630

0007

Your Vehicle at a Glance
AIRBAGS (P.11, 23)
INDICATORS (P.58)
GAUGES (P.64)

MIRROR CONTROLS
(P.90)

AUDIO SYSTEM
(P.114)
HEATING/COOLING
CONTROLS
(P.102)

POWER DOOR LOCK
MASTER SWITCH
(P.77)

SHIFT LEVER
(P.170, 173)

POWER WINDOW
SWITCHES
(P.91)

TRUNK RELEASE LEVER
(P.82)
FUEL FILL DOOR RELEASE LEVER
(P.156)

HOOD RELEASE
HANDLE
(P.157)

ACCESSORY POWER SOCKETS
(P.99)

4

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/06/03

09:25:32

31SDA630

0008

Your Vehicle at a Glance

PASSENGER AIRBAG
OFF INDICATOR
(P.31)

Your Vehicle at a Glance

WINDSHIELD WIPERS/
WASHERS
(P.68)

INSTRUMENT PANEL
BRIGHTNESS
(P.71)
HEADLIGHTS/
TURN SIGNALS
(P.69)

HAZARD
WARNING BUTTON
(P.71)

REMOTE AUDIO
CONTROLS
(P.141)

CRUISE CONTROLS
(P.145)

VOICE CONTROL
SWITCHES*
MOONROOF
SWITCH
(P.94)

REAR WINDOW
DEFOGGER
(P.72, 108)

VSA OFF SWITCH
(P.183)

STEERING WHEEL
ADJUSTMENT
(P.73)

HORN

* : Only on vehicles equipped with navigation system. Refer to the navigation system manual.

5

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/06/03

09:25:38

31SDA630

0010

Driver and Passenger Safety

Important Safety Precautions .......... 8
Your Vehicle’s Safety Features........ 9
Seat Belts ...................................... 10
Airbags .......................................... 11
Protecting Adults and Teens.......... 13
1. Close and Lock the Doors ...... 13
2. Adjust the Front Seats ............ 13
3. Adjust the Seat-Backs ............. 14
4. Adjust the Head Restraints .... 15
5. Fasten and Position the Seat
Belts ...................................... 16
6. Maintain a Proper Sitting
Position ................................. 17
Advice for Pregnant Women...... 18

Additional Safety Precautions .... 19
Additional Information About Your
Seat Belts .................................. 20
Seat Belt System Components ... 20
Lap/Shoulder Belt ....................... 21
Automatic Seat Belt Tensioners ........ 21
Seat Belt Maintenance ................ 22
Additional Information About Your
Airbags ...................................... 23
Airbag System Components ....... 23
How Your Front Airbags
Work.......................................... 25
How Your Side Airbags Work.... 28
How Your Side Curtain Airbags
Work.......................................... 30
How the SRS Indicator Works ... 30
How the Side Airbag Off
Indicator Works ....................... 31
How the Passenger Airbag Off
Indicator Works ....................... 31
Airbag Service .............................. 32
Additional Safety Precautions .... 33
Protecting Children − General
Guidelines ................................. 34
All Children Must Be
Restrained ................................ 34

All Children Should Sit in a
Back Seat .................................. 35
The Passenger’s Front Airbag
Poses Serious Risks................. 35
If You Must Drive with Several
Children .................................... 37
If a Child Requires Close
Attention ................................... 37
Additional Safety Precautions .... 37
Protecting Infants and
Small Children.......................... 38
Protecting Infants ........................ 38
Protecting Small Children .......... 40
Selecting a Child Seat ...................... 41
Installing a Child Seat ..................... 42
With LATCH ................................ 43
With a Belt .................................... 45
With a Tether ............................... 47
Protecting Larger Children ............ 48
Using a Booster Seat ................... 49
When Can a Larger Child Sit in
Front .......................................... 50
Additional Safety Precautions .... 51
Carbon Monoxide Hazard .............. 52
Safety Labels .................................... 53

7

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Driver and Passenger Safety

This section gives you important
information about how to protect
yourself and your passengers. It
shows you how to use seat belts. It
explains how your airbags work. And
it tells you how to properly restrain
infants and children in your vehicle.

05/06/03

09:25:48

31SDA630

0011

Important Safety Precautions
You’ll find many safety
recommendations throughout this
section, and throughout this manual.
The recommendations on this page
are the ones we consider to be the
most important.
Always Wear Your Seat Belt
A seat belt is your best protection in
all types of collisions. Airbags are
designed to supplement seat belts,
not replace them. So even though
your vehicle is equipped with airbags,
make sure you and your passengers
always wear your seat belts, and
wear them properly (see page 16 ).
Restrain All Children
Children age 12 and under should
ride properly restrained in a back
seat. Infants and small children
should be restrained in a child seat.
Larger children should use a booster
and a lap/shoulder belt until they
can use the belt properly without a
booster (see pages 34 − 51 ).

Be Aware of Airbag Hazards
While airbags can save lives, they
can cause serious or fatal injuries to
occupants who sit too close to them,
or are not properly restrained.
Infants, young children, and short
adults are at the greatest risk. Be
sure to follow all instructions and
warnings in this manual.

Control Your Speed
Excessive speed is a major factor in
crash injuries and deaths. Generally,
the higher the speed, the greater the
risk, but serious injuries can also
occur at lower speeds. Never drive
faster than is safe for current
conditions, regardless of the
maximum speed posted.

Don’t Drink and Drive
Alcohol and driving don’t mix. Even
one drink can reduce your ability to
respond to changing conditions, and
your reaction time gets worse with
every additional drink. So don’t drink
and drive, and don’t let your friends
drink and drive, either.

Keep Your Vehicle in Safe
Condition
Having a tire blowout or a
mechanical failure can be extremely
hazardous. To reduce the possibility
of such problems, check your tire
pressures and condition frequently,
and perform all regularly scheduled
maintenance (see page 193 ).

8

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/06/03

09:25:54

31SDA630

0012

Your Vehicle’s Safety Features

(3)

(10) (8) (9) (1)

(4)

(8)

Some features do not require any
action on your part. These include a
strong steel framework that forms a
safety cage around the passenger
compartment; front and rear crush
zones; a collapsible steering column;
and tensioners that tighten the front
seat belts in a crash.

(7)

(5)

(2)

(7)

(6)
(11)

(1) Safety Cage
(2) Crush Zones
(3) Seats and Seat-Backs
(4) Head Restraints
(5) Collapsible Steering Column
(6) Seat Belts
(7) Front Airbags
(8) Side Airbags
(9) Side Curtain Airbags
(10) Door Locks
(11) Seat Belt Tensioners

However, you and your passengers
can’t take full advantage of these
features unless you remain sitting in
a proper position and always wear
your seat belts. In fact, some safety
features can contribute to injuries if
they are not used properly.
The following pages explain how you
can take an active role in protecting
yourself and your passengers.

9

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Driver and Passenger Safety

(2)

Your vehicle is equipped with many
features that work together to
protect you and your passengers
during a crash.

05/06/09

09:12:24

31SDA630

0013

Your Vehicle’s Safety Features
Seat Belts
Your vehicle is equipped with seat
belts in all seating positions.
Your seat belt system also
includes an indicator on the
instrument panel and a beeper to
remind you and your passengers to
fasten your seat belts.

Not wearing a seat belt properly
increases the chance of serious
injury or death in a crash, even
though your vehicle has airbags.
Be sure you and your
passengers always wear seat
belts and wear them properly.

Why Wear Seat Belts

Seat belts are the single most
effective safety device for adults and
larger children. (Infants and smaller
children must be properly restrained
in child seats.)
Not wearing a seat belt properly
increases the chance of serious
injury or death in a crash, even
though your vehicle has airbags.

When properly worn, seat belts:
Keep you connected to the vehicle
so you can take advantage of the
vehicle’s built-in safety features.
Help protect you in almost every
type of crash, including frontal,
side, and rear impacts and
rollovers.

In addition, most states and all
Canadian provinces require you to
wear seat belts.

10

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Help keep you from being thrown
against the inside of the vehicle
and against other occupants.
Keep you from being thrown out
of the vehicle.
Help keep you in a good position
should the airbags ever deploy. A
good position reduces the risk of
injury from an inflating airbag and
allows you to get the best
advantage from the airbag.
Of course, seat belts cannot
completely protect you in every
crash. But in most cases, seat belts
can reduce your risk of serious
injury.
What You Should Do:

Always wear your seat belt, and
make sure you wear it properly.

05/06/03

09:26:13

31SDA630

0014

Your Vehicle’s Safety Features
Airbags

Driver and Passenger Safety

Your vehicle has a supplemental
restraint system (SRS) with front
airbags to help protect the heads and
chests of the driver and a front seat
passenger during a moderate to
severe frontal collision (see page
25 for more information on how
your front airbags work).

Your vehicle has side airbags to help
protect the upper torso of the driver
or a front seat passenger during a
moderate to severe side impact (see
page 28 for more information on how
your side airbags work).

Your vehicle also has side curtain
airbags to help protect the heads of
the driver, front passenger, and
passengers in the outer rear seating
positions during a moderate to
severe side impact (see page 30 for
more information on how your side
curtain airbags work).

CONTINUED

11

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/06/03

09:26:19

31SDA630

0015

Your Vehicle’s Safety Features
The most important things you need
to know about your airbags are:
Airbags do not replace seat belts.

They are designed to supplement
the seat belts.
Airbags offer no protection in rear
impacts, or minor frontal or side
collisions.

What you should do: Always wear
your seat belt properly, and sit
upright and as far back from the
steering wheel as possible while
allowing full control of the vehicle. A
front passenger should move their
seat as far back from the dashboard
as possible.

Airbags can pose hazards. To do
their job, airbags must inflate with
tremendous force. So while
airbags help save lives, they can
cause minor injuries or more
serious or even fatal injuries if
occupants are not properly
restrained or sitting properly.

12

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

The rest of this section gives more
detailed information about how you
can maximize your safety.
Remember, however, that no safety
system can prevent all injuries or
deaths that can occur in a severe
crash, even when seat belts are
properly worn and the airbags deploy.

05/06/03

09:26:29

31SDA630

0016

Protecting Adults and Teens

See pages 34 − 51 for important
guidelines on how to properly
protect infants, small children, and
larger children who ride in your
vehicle.
1.Close and Lock the Doors
After everyone has entered the
vehicle, be sure the doors are closed
and locked.

Locking the doors reduces the
chance of someone being thrown out
of the vehicle during a crash, and it
helps prevent passengers from
accidentally opening a door and
falling out.

2.Adjust the Front Seats

Driver and Passenger Safety

Introduction
The following pages provide
instructions on how to properly
protect the driver, adult passengers,
and teenage children who are large
enough and mature enough to drive
or ride in the front.

Locking the doors also helps prevent
an outsider from unexpectedly
opening a door when you come to a
stop.
See page 77 for how to lock the
doors, and page 60 for how the door
monitor indicator works.

Adjust the driver’s seat as far to the
rear as possible while allowing you to
maintain full control of the vehicle.
Have a front passenger adjust their
seat as far to the rear as possible.

Your vehicle has a door
monitor indicator on the
instrument panel to indicate when a
specific door or the trunk is not
tightly closed.
CONTINUED

13

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/06/03

09:26:37

31SDA630

0017

Protecting Adults and Teens
If you sit too close to the steering
wheel or dashboard, you can be
seriously injured by an inflating front
airbag, or by striking the steering
wheel or dashboard.
The National Highway Traffic Safety
Administration and Transport
Canada recommend that drivers
allow at least 10 inches (25 cm)
between the center of the steering
wheel and the chest. In addition to
adjusting the seat, you can adjust the
steering wheel in and out (see page
73 ).
If you cannot get far enough away
from the steering wheel and still
reach the controls, we recommend
that you investigate whether some
type of adaptive equipment may help.

3.Adjust the Seat-Backs
Sitting too close to a front
airbag can result in serious
injury or death if the front
airbags inflate.
Always sit as far back from the
front airbags as possible.
Once your seat is adjusted correctly,
rock it back and forth to make sure
the seat is locked in position.
See page 85 for how to adjust the
front seats.

Adjust the driver’s seat-back to a
comfortable, upright position,
leaving ample space between your
chest and the airbag cover in the
center of the steering wheel.
Passengers with adjustable seatbacks should also adjust their seatback to a comfortable, upright
position.

14

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/06/03

09:26:45

31SDA630

0018

Protecting Adults and Teens
4.Adjust the Head Restraints

Adjust the seat-back to an
upright position, and sit well
back in the seat.
Reclining a seat-back so that the
shoulder part of the belt no longer
rests against the occupant’s chest
reduces the protective capability of
the belt. It also increases the chance
of sliding under the belt in a crash
and being seriously injured. The
farther a seat-back is reclined, the
greater the risk of injury.
See page 85 for how to adjust the
seat-backs.

Make sure head restraints are
in place and positioned properly
before driving.

Adjust the driver’s head restraint so
the back of your head rests against
the center of the restraint.

Properly adjusted head restraints
will help protect occupants from
whiplash and other crash injuries.
See page 87 for how to adjust the
head restraints.

Have passengers with adjustable
head restraints adjust their restraints
properly as well. Taller persons
should adjust their restraint as high
as possible.

15

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Driver and Passenger Safety

Improperly positioning head
restraints reduces their
effectiveness and you can be
seriously injured in a crash.

Reclining the seat-back too far
can result in serious injury or
death in a crash.

05/06/03

09:26:52

31SDA630

0019

Protecting Adults and Teens
This spreads the forces of a crash
over the strongest bones in your
upper body.

5.Fasten and Position the Seat
Belts
Insert the latch plate into the buckle,
then tug on the belt to make sure the
belt is securely latched. Check that
the belt is not twisted, because a
twisted belt can cause serious
injuries in a crash.

Improperly positioning the seat
belts can cause serious injury
or death in a crash.
Make sure all seat belts are
properly positioned before
driving.
Position the lap part of the belt as
low as possible across your hips,
then pull up on the shoulder part of
the belt so the lap part fits snugly.
This lets your strong pelvic bones
take the force of a crash and reduces
the chance of internal injuries.
If necessary, pull up on the belt again
to remove any slack, then check that
the belt rests across the center of
your chest and over your shoulder.

16

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

If the seat belt touches or crosses
your neck, or if it crosses your arm
instead of your shoulder, you need to
adjust the seat belt anchor height.

05/06/03

09:27:00

31SDA630

0020

Protecting Adults and Teens
RELEASE
BUTTONS

Never place the shoulder portion of a
lap/shoulder belt under your arm or
behind your back. This could cause

If a seat belt does not seem to work
properly, it may not protect the
occupant in a crash.
No one should sit in a seat with an
inoperative seat belt. Using a seat

The front seats have adjustable seat
belt anchors. To adjust the height of
an anchor, press and hold the release
buttons, and slide the anchor up or
down as needed (it has four
positions).

belt that is not working properly can
result in serious injury or death.
Have your dealer check the belt as
soon as possible.
See page 20 for additional
information about your seat belts
and how to take care of them.

Sitting improperly can increase the
chance of injury during a crash. For
example, if an occupant slouches,
lies down, turns sideways, sits
forward, leans forward or sideways,
or puts one or both feet up, the
chance of injury during a crash is
greatly increased.

CONTINUED

17

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Driver and Passenger Safety

very serious injuries in a crash.

6.Maintain a Proper Sitting
Position
After all occupants have adjusted
their seats and put on seat belts, it is
very important that they continue to
sit upright, well back in their seats,
with their feet on the floor, until the
vehicle is parked and the engine is
off.

05/06/03

09:27:06

31SDA630

0021

Protecting Adults and Teens
In addition, an occupant who is out of
position in the front seat can be
seriously or fatally injured in a crash
by striking interior parts of the
vehicle or being struck by an
inflating front airbag.

Advice for Pregnant Women

This will reduce the risk of injuries
to both you and your unborn child
that can be caused by a crash or an
inflating front airbag.

Sitting improperly or out of
position can result in serious
injury or death in a crash.
Always sit upright, well back in
the seat, with your feet on the
floor.

When driving, remember to sit
upright and adjust the seat as far
back as possible while allowing full
control of the vehicle. When riding
as a front passenger, adjust the seat
as far back as possible.

If you are pregnant, the best way to
protect yourself and your unborn
child when driving or riding in a
vehicle is to always wear a seat belt,
and keep the lap part of the belt as
low as possible across the hips.

18

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Each time you have a checkup, ask
your doctor if it’s okay for you to
drive.

05/06/03

09:27:12

31SDA630

0022

Protecting Adults and Teens
Additional Safety Precautions
Two people should never use the
same seat belt. If they do, they

Keep your hands and arms away
from the airbag covers. If your

hands or arms are close to an
airbag cover, they could be injured
if the airbag inflates.

Do not put any accessories on seat
belts. Devices intended to improve

Do not attach or place objects on
the front airbag covers. Objects on

occupant comfort or reposition the
shoulder part of a seat belt can
reduce the protective capability of
the belt and increase the chance of
serious injury in a crash.

the covers marked ‘‘SRS AIRBAG’’
could interfere with the proper
operation of the airbags or be
propelled inside the vehicle and
hurt someone if the airbags inflate.

Do not place hard or sharp objects
between yourself and a front
airbag. Carrying hard or sharp

Do not attach hard objects on or
near a door. If a side airbag or a

objects on your lap, or driving with
a pipe or other sharp object in
your mouth, can result in injuries
if your front airbag inflates.

Driver and Passenger Safety

could be very seriously injured in a
crash.

side curtain airbag inflates, a cup
holder or other hard object
attached on or near the door could
be propelled inside the vehicle and
hurt someone.

19

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/06/03

09:27:21

31SDA630

0023

Additional Information About Your Seat Belts
Seat Belt System Components
Your seat belt system includes lap/
shoulder belts in all five seating
positions. The front seat belts are
also equipped with automatic seat
belt tensioners.
The seat belt system
includes an indicator on the
instrument panel and a beeper to
remind you and your passengers to
fasten your seat belts.
This system monitors the front seat
belts. If you turn the ignition switch
to the ON (II) position before your
seat belt is fastened, the beeper will
sound and the indicator will flash. If
your seat belt is not fastened before
the beeper stops, the indicator will
stop flashing but remain on.

If a front passenger does not fasten
their seat belt, the indicator will
come on about 6 seconds after the
ignition switch is turned to the ON
(II) position.
If either the driver or a front
passenger does not fasten their seat
belt while driving, the beeper will
sound and the indicator will flash
again at regular intervals.
When no one is sitting in the front
passenger’s seat, or a small child is
riding there, the indicator will not
come on and the beeper will not
sound.

20

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

The seat belts use the same
monitoring system as the front
airbags. The system may not work
properly under these conditions:
Placing heavy items on the front
passenger’s seat.
The front passenger is not sitting
properly.
The front passenger’s seat-back is
pressed forward by a folded-down
rear seat.
Have your vehicle checked by a
dealer if the indicator comes on or
the beeper sounds when there is no
front passenger or objects on the
front seat.

05/06/03

09:27:30

31SDA630

0024

Additional Information About Your Seat Belts

To fasten the belt, insert the latch
plate into the buckle, then tug on the
belt to make sure the buckle is
latched (see page 16 for how to
properly position the belt).
To unlock the belt, press the red
PRESS button on the buckle. Guide
the belt across your body so that it
retracts completely. After exiting the
vehicle, be sure the belt is out of the
way and will not get closed in the
door.

restrain your body.

Automatic Seat Belt Tensioners

The seat belts in all positions except
the driver’s have an additional
locking mechanism that must be
activated to secure a child seat (see
page 45 ).

Driver and Passenger Safety

Lap/Shoulder Belt
The lap and shoulder belt goes over
your shoulder, across your chest,
and across your hips.

If the shoulder part of the belt is
pulled all the way out, the locking
mechanism will activate. The belt
will retract, but it will not allow the
passenger to move freely.
To deactivate the locking
mechanism, unlatch the buckle and
let the seat belt fully retract. To
refasten the seat belt, pull it out only
as far as needed.

All seat belts have an emergency
locking retractor. In normal driving,
the retractor lets you move freely in
your seat while it keeps some
tension on the belt. During a collision
or sudden stop, the retractor
automatically locks the belt to help

For added protection, the front seat
belts are equipped with automatic
seat belt tensioners. When activated,
the tensioners immediately tighten
the belts to help hold the driver and
a front passenger in place.

CONTINUED

21

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/06/03

09:27:39

31SDA630

0025

Additional Information About Your Seat Belts
The tensioners are designed to
activate in any collision severe
enough to cause the front airbags to
deploy.

Seat Belt Maintenance
For safety, you should check the
condition of your seat belts regularly.

The tensioners can also be activated
during a collision in which the front
airbags do not deploy. In this case, the
airbags would not be needed, but the
additional restraint could be helpful.

Pull each belt out fully, and look for
frays, cuts, burns, and wear. Check
that the latches work smoothly and
the belts retract easily. If a belt does
not retract easily, cleaning the belt
may correct the problem (see page
224 ). Any belt that is not in good
condition or working properly will
not provide good protection and
should be replaced as soon as
possible.

When the tensioners are activated,
the seat belts will remain tight until
they are unbuckled in the normal
manner.

Honda provides a lifetime warranty
on seat belts for U.S. models. See
your Honda Warranty Information
booklet for details.

If the front seat belt tensioners ever
activate, they must be replaced as
the belts will no longer retract
properly.

If a seat belt is worn during a crash,
it must be replaced by the dealer. A
belt that has been worn during a
crash may not provide the same level
of protection in a subsequent crash.

If a side curtain airbag deploys
during a side impact, the tensioner
on that side of the vehicle will also
deploy.

22

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

The dealer should also inspect the
anchors for damage and replace
them if needed. If the automatic seat
belt tensioners activate during a
crash, they must be replaced.
For information on how to clean your
seat belts, see page 224 .

Not checking or maintaining
seat belts can result in serious
injury or death if the seat belts
do not work properly when
needed.
Check your seat belts regularly
and have any problem
corrected as soon as possible.

05/06/03

09:27:47

31SDA630

0026

Additional Information About Your Airbags
Your airbag system includes:

Airbag System Components

(8)

(9)

(2)

(11)

(8)
(5)

Two SRS (supplemental restraint
system) front airbags. The driver’s
airbag is stored in the center of
the steering wheel; the front
passenger’s airbag is stored in the
dashboard. Both are marked ‘‘SRS
AIRBAG’’ (see page 25 ).
Two side airbags, one for the
driver and one for a front
passenger. The airbags are stored
in the outer edges of the seatbacks. Both are marked ‘‘SIDE
AIRBAG’’ (see page 28 ).

(1) Driver’s Airbag
(2) Front Passenger’s Airbag
(3) Control Unit
(4) Front Seat Belt Tensioners
(3)
(5) Side Airbags
(6) Driver’s Seat Position Sensor
(7) Front Passenger’s Weight Sensors
(8) Front Impact Sensors
(10)
(4)
(9) Passenger’s Airbag Off Indicator
(6)
(10) Side Impact Sensors
(11) Occupant Position Detection System (OPDS) Sensors

(10) (4)
(7)
(5)

(7)

Two side curtain airbags, one for
each side of the vehicle. The
airbags are stored in the ceiling
above the side windows. The front
and rear pillars are marked ‘‘SIDE
CURTAIN AIRBAG’’ (see page
30 ).
CONTINUED

23

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Driver and Passenger Safety

(1)

05/06/03

09:27:55

31SDA630

0027

Additional Information About Your Airbags
Automatic front seat belt
tensioners (see page 21 ).
Sensors that can detect a
moderate to severe front impact or
side impact.
Sensors that can detect whether a
child is in the passenger’s side
airbag path and signal the control
unit to turn the airbag off (see
page 27 ).
A driver’s seat position sensor that
monitors the distance of the seat
from the front airbag. If the seat is
too far forward, the airbag will
inflate with less force (see page
27 ).

Weight sensors that monitor the
weight on the front passenger’s
seat. If the weight of an infant or
small child is detected, the
passenger’s front airbag will be
turned off.
A sophisticated electronic system
that continually monitors and
records information about the
sensors, the control unit, the
airbag activators, the seat belt
tensioners, and driver and front
passenger seat belt use when the
ignition is in ON (II).
An indicator on the instrument
panel that alerts you to a possible
problem with your airbags,
sensors, or seat belt tensioners
(see page 30 ).

24

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

An indicator on the instrument
panel that alerts you that the
passenger’s side airbag has been
turned off (see page 31 ).
An indicator on the dashboard that
alerts you that the front
passenger’s side airbag has been
turned off (see page 31 ).
Emergency backup power in case
your vehicle’s electrical system is
disconnected in a crash.

05/06/03

09:28:03

31SDA630

0028

Additional Information About Your Airbags
How Your Front Airbags Work

Driver and Passenger Safety

During a frontal crash, your seat belt
restrains your lower body and torso,
and the front airbag helps protect
your head and chest.
Although both airbags normally
inflate within a split second of each
other, it is possible for only one
airbag to deploy.

If you ever have a moderate to
severe frontal collision, sensors will
detect the vehicle’s rapid
deceleration.

This can happen if the severity of a
collision is at the margin, or
threshold, that determines whether
or not the airbags will deploy. In
such cases, the seat belt will provide
sufficient protection, and the
supplemental protection offered by
the airbag would be minimal.

If the rate of deceleration is high
enough, the control unit will instantly
inflate the driver’s and front
passenger’s airbags, at the time and
with the force needed.

Only the driver’s airbag can deploy if
there is no passenger in the front
seat, or if the advanced airbag
system has turned the passenger’s
airbag off (see page 31 ).

After inflating, the front airbags will
immediately deflate, so they won’t
interfere with the driver’s visibility,
or the ability to steer or operate
other controls.
The total time for inflation and
deflation is one-tenth of a second, so
fast that most occupants are not
aware that the airbags deployed until
they see them lying in their laps.
CONTINUED

25

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/06/03

09:28:10

31SDA630

0029

Additional Information About Your Airbags
After a crash, you may see what
looks like smoke. This is actually
powder from the airbag’s surface.
Although the powder is not harmful,
people with respiratory problems
may experience some temporary
discomfort. If this occurs, get out of
the vehicle as soon as it is safe to do
so.

Dual-Stage Airbags

Dual-Threshold Airbags

Your front airbags are dual-stage
airbags. This means they have two
inflation stages that can be ignited
sequentially or simultaneously,
depending on crash severity.

Your front airbags are also dualthreshold airbags. Airbags with this
feature have two deployment
thresholds that depend on whether
or not the occupant is wearing a seat
belt.

In a more severe crash, both stages
will ignite simultaneously to provide
the quickest and greatest protection.
In a less severe crash, one stage will
ignite first, then the second stage
will ignite a split second later. This
provides longer airbag inflation time
with a little less force.

26

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

If the occupant’s belt is not latched,
the airbag will deploy at a slightly
lower threshold, because the
occupant would need extra
protection.
If the occupant’s belt is latched, the
airbag will inflate at a slightly higher
threshold, when the airbag would be
needed to supplement the protection
provided by the seat belt.

05/06/03

09:28:19

31SDA630

0030

Additional Information About Your Airbags
Advanced Airbags

For both advanced airbags to work
properly:

DRIVER’S
SEAT
POSITION
SENSOR

Occupants must sit upright and
wear their seat belts properly.
Do not spill any liquids on or
under the seats, cover the sensors,
or put any cargo or metal objects
under the front seats.
Back-seat passengers should not
put their feet under the front seats.
Failure to follow these instructions
could damage the sensors or prevent
them from working properly.

The driver’s advanced front airbag
system includes a seat position
sensor under the seat. If the seat is
too far forward, the airbag will
inflate with less force, regardless of
the severity of the impact.
If there is a problem with the sensor,
the SRS Indicator will come on, and
the airbag will inflate in the normal
manner regardless of the driver’s
seating position.

PASSENGER’S
SEAT WEIGHT
SENSOR

The passenger’s advanced front
airbag system has weight sensors
under the seat. Although Honda
does not encourage carrying an
infant or small child in front, if the
sensors detect the weight of an
infant or small child, the system will
automatically turn the passenger’s
front airbag off.

CONTINUED

27

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Driver and Passenger Safety

Your front airbags are also advanced
airbags. The main purpose of this
feature is to help prevent airbagcaused injuries to short drivers and
children who ride in front.

05/06/03

09:28:26

31SDA630

0031

Additional Information About Your Airbags
When the airbag is turned off, an
indicator in the center of the
dashboard will come on indicating
passenger airbag ‘‘OFF’’ (see page
31 ).
If the weight sensors detect that
there is no passenger in the front
seat, the airbag will be off. However,
the Passenger Airbag Off indicator
will not come on.
To ensure that the passenger’s
advanced front airbag system will
work properly, do not do anything

Moving the front seat forcibly
back against cargo on the seat or
floor behind it.

How Your Side Airbags Work

Hanging heavy items on the front
passenger seat, or placing heavy
items in the seat-back pocket.
Also, make sure the floor mat behind
the front passenger’s seat is hooked
to the floor mat anchor (see page
224 ). If it is not, the mat may
interfere with the proper operation
of the sensors and operation of the
seat.

that would increase or decrease the
weight on the front passenger’s seat.

This includes:
A rear passenger pushing or
pulling on the back of the
passenger’s seat.

28

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

If you ever have a moderate to
severe side impact, sensors will
detect rapid deceleration and signal
the control unit to instantly inflate
either the driver’s or the passenger’s
side airbag.

05/06/03

09:28:34

31SDA630

0032

Additional Information About Your Airbags

To get the best protection from the
side airbags, front seat occupants
should wear their seat belts and sit
upright and well back in their seats.

Side Airbag Cutoff System

Your vehicle has a side airbag cutoff
system designed primarily to protect
a child riding in the front passenger’s
seat.
Although Honda does not encourage
children to ride in front, if the height
and position sensors in the seat
detect a child has leaned into the
side airbag’s deployment path, the
airbag will shut off.
The side airbag may also shut off if a
short adult leans sideways, or a
larger adult slouches and leans
sideways into the airbag’s
deployment path.

If the side airbag off indicator comes
on (see page 31 ), have the
passenger sit upright. Once the
passenger is out of the airbag’s
deployment path, the system will
turn the airbag back on, and the
indicator will go out.
There will be some delay between
the moment the passenger moves
into or out of the airbag deployment
path and when the indicator comes
on or goes off.
A front seat passenger should not
use a cushion or other object as a
backrest. It may prevent the cutoff
system from working properly.

Objects placed on the front
passenger seat can also cause the
side airbag to be shut off.

29

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Driver and Passenger Safety

Only one airbag will deploy during a
side impact. If the impact is on the
passenger’s side, the passenger’s
side airbag will deploy even if there
is no passenger.

05/06/03

09:28:43

31SDA630

0033

Additional Information About Your Airbags
How Your Side Curtain Airbags
Work

If the impact is on the passenger’s
side, the passenger’s side curtain
airbag will inflate even if there are no
occupants on that side of the vehicle.
To get the best protection from the
side curtain airbags, occupants
should wear their seat belts and sit
upright and well back in their seats.

How the SRS Indicator Works
The SRS indicator alerts
you to a potential problem
with your airbags or seat belt
tensioners.
When you turn the ignition switch to
the ON (II) position, this indicator
comes on briefly then goes off. This
tells you the system is working
properly.
If the indicator comes on at any
other time, or does not come on at all,
you should have the system checked
by your dealer. For example:

SIDE CURTAIN AIRBAG

In a moderate to severe side impact,
sensors will detect rapid deceleration
and signal the control unit to
instantly inflate the side curtain
airbag on the driver’s or the
passenger’s side of the vehicle.

If the SRS indicator does not come
on after you turn the ignition
switch to the ON (II) position.
If the indicator stays on after the
engine starts.
If the indicator comes on or
flashes on and off while you drive.

30

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/06/03

09:28:52

31SDA630

0034

Additional Information About Your Airbags

Ignoring the SRS indicator can
result in serious injury or death
if the airbag systems or
tensioners do not work properly.
Have your vehicle checked by a
dealer as soon as possible if
the SRS indicator alerts you to
a possible problem.

How the Side Airbag Off
Indicator Works
U.S.
Canada This indicator
alerts you that the
passenger’s side
airbag has been automatically shut
off. It does not mean there is a
problem with your side airbags.
When you turn the ignition switch to
the ON (II) position, the indicator
should come on briefly and then go
out (see page 59 ). If it doesn’t come
on, stays on, or comes on while
driving without a passenger in the
front seat, have the system checked.

How the Passenger Airbag Off
Indicator Works

U.S.

Canada

PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF INDICATOR

This indicator alerts you that the
passenger’s front airbag has been
shut off because weight sensors
detect the weight of an infant or
small child on the front passenger’s
seat. It does not mean there is a
problem with the airbag.

CONTINUED

31

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Driver and Passenger Safety

If you see any of these indications,
the airbags and seat belt tensioners
may not work properly when you
need them.

05/06/03

09:28:59

31SDA630

0035

Additional Information About Your Airbags
If no one is riding in the front seat,
the airbag will be automatically shut
off. However, the indicator will not
come on.
However, if the indicator comes on
with no passenger in the front, or
with an adult in the seat, there may
be a problem with the advanced
airbag system. Have the vehicle
checked by the dealer as soon as
possible.
The passenger airbag off indicator
may also come on and off repeatedly
if total weight on the seat is near the
airbag cutoff threshold.

Airbag Service
Your airbag systems are virtually
maintenance free, and there are no
parts you can safely service.
However, you must have your
vehicle serviced if:
An airbag ever inflates. Any airbag
that has deployed must be
replaced along with the control
unit and other related parts. If a
front airbag inflates, the seat belt
tensioners must also be replaced.

Do not try to remove or replace
any airbag by yourself. This must
be done by your dealer or a
knowledgeable body shop.

If this happens, have the passenger
ride properly restrained in a back
seat. If the passenger must ride in
front, move the seat as far to the
rear as possible, have the passenger
sit upright and wear the seat belt
properly.

32

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

The SRS indicator alerts you to a
problem. Take your vehicle to an

authorized dealer as soon as
possible. If you ignore this
indication, your airbags may not
operate properly.
If your vehicle has a moderate to
severe impact. Even if your

airbags do not inflate, your dealer
should inspect the driver’s seat
position sensor and the front
passenger’s weight sensors to
make sure they are operating
properly.

05/06/03

09:29:04

31SDA630

0036

Additional Information About Your Airbags
Additional Safety Precautions
Do not attempt to deactivate your
airbags. Together, airbags and

or covering front seat-back covers
can prevent your side airbags from
inflating during a side impact.

Driver and Passenger Safety

seat belts provide the best
protection.

Do not cover or replace front seatback covers without consulting
your dealer. Improperly replacing

Do not tamper with airbag
components or wiring for any
reason. Tampering could cause

the airbags to deploy, possibly
causing very serious injury.
Do not remove or modify a front
seat without consulting your
dealer. This could make the

driver’s seat position sensor or the
front passenger’s weight sensors
ineffective. If it is necessary to
remove or modify a front seat to
accommodate a person with
disabilities, first contact Honda
Automobile Customer Service at
(800) 999-1009.

33

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/06/03

09:29:11

31SDA630

0037

Protecting Children − General Guidelines
All Children Must Be Restrained
Each year, many children are injured
or killed in vehicle crashes because
they are either unrestrained or not
properly restrained. In fact, vehicle
accidents are the number one cause
of the death of children ages 12 and
under.

Children depend on adults to protect
them. However, despite their best
intentions, many adults do not know
how to properly protect child
passengers.
If you have children, or ever need to
drive with a child in your vehicle, be
sure to read this section. It begins
with important general guidelines,
then presents special information for
infants, small children, and larger
children.

To reduce the number of child
deaths and injuries, every state and
Canadian province requires that
infants and children be properly
restrained when they ride in a
vehicle.
Infants and small children must be
restrained in an approved child seat
that is properly secured to the
vehicle (see pages 38 − 47 ).

34

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Children who are unrestrained
or improperly restrained can be
seriously injured or killed in a
crash.
Any child too small for a seat
belt should be properly
restrained in a child seat. A
larger child should be properly
restrained with a seat belt and
use a booster seat if necessary.
Larger children must be restrained
with a lap/shoulder belt and ride on
a booster seat until the seat belt fits
them properly (see pages 48 − 51 ).

05/06/03

09:29:21

31SDA630

0038

Protecting Children − General Guidelines

The National Highway Traffic Safety
Administration and Transport
Canada recommend that all children
age 12 and under be properly
restrained in a back seat. Some
states have laws restricting where
children may ride.
Children who ride in back are less
likely to be injured by striking
interior vehicle parts during a
collision or hard braking. Also,
children cannot be injured by an
inflating front airbag when they ride
in the back.

The Passenger’s Front Airbag
Poses Serious Risks
Front airbags have been designed to
help protect adults in a moderate to
severe frontal collision. To do this,
the passenger’s front airbag is quite
large, and it can inflate with enough
force to cause very serious injuries.
Even though your vehicle has an
advanced front airbag system, which
can automatically turn the
passenger’s front airbag off (see
page 27 ), please follow the
guidelines below.
Infants
Never put a rear-facing child seat in
the front seat of a vehicle equipped
with a passenger’s front airbag. If

the airbag inflates, it can hit the back
of the child seat with enough force
to kill or very seriously injure an
infant.

Small Children
Placing a forward-facing child seat in
the front seat of a vehicle equipped
with a passenger’s front airbag can
be hazardous. If the vehicle seat is

too far forward, or the child’s head is
thrown forward during a collision, an
inflating front airbag can strike the
child with enough force to kill or
very seriously injure a small child.
Larger Children
Children who have outgrown child
seats are also at risk of being injured
or killed by an inflating passenger’s
front airbag. Whenever possible,

larger children should sit in the back
seat, on a booster seat if needed, and
be properly restrained with a seat
belt (see page 48 for important
information about protecting larger
children).

CONTINUED

35

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Driver and Passenger Safety

All Children Should Sit in a Back
Seat
According to accident statistics,
children of all ages and sizes are
safer when they are restrained in a
back seat.

05/06/03

09:29:35

31SDA630

0039

Protecting Children − General Guidelines
To remind you of the passenger’s
front airbag hazards, and that
children must be properly restrained
in a back seat, your vehicle has
warning labels on the dashboard
(U.S. models) and on the front visors.
Please read and follow the
instructions on these labels.

U.S. Models

DASHBOARD

SUN VISOR

Canadian Models
SUN VISOR

36

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/06/03

09:29:44

31SDA630

0040

Protecting Children − General Guidelines

Place the largest child in the front
seat, provided the child is large
enough to wear the lap/shoulder
belt properly (see page 48 ).
Move the vehicle seat as far to the
rear as possible (see page 13 ).
Have the child sit upright and well
back in the seat (see page 16 ).
Make sure the seat belt is properly
positioned and secured (see page
16 ).

If a Child Requires Close
Attention
Many parents say they prefer to put
an infant or small child in the front
passenger seat so they can watch the
child, or because the child requires
attention.
Placing a child in the front seat
exposes the child to hazards in a
frontal collision, and paying close
attention to a child distracts the
driver from the important tasks of
driving, placing both of you at risk.
If a child requires close physical
attention or frequent visual
contact, we strongly recommend
that another adult ride with the
child in a back seat. The back seat
is far safer for a child than the
front.

Additional Safety Precautions
Never hold an infant or child on
your lap. If you are not wearing a

seat belt in crash, you could be
thrown forward and crush the
child against the dashboard or a
seat-back. If you are wearing a
seat belt, the child can be torn
from your arms and be seriously
hurt or killed.
Never put a seat belt over yourself
and a child. During a crash, the

belt could press deep into the child
and cause serious or fatal injuries.
Never let two children use the
same seat belt. If they do, they

could be very seriously injured in a
crash.

37

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Driver and Passenger Safety

If You Must Drive with Several
Children
Your vehicle has a back seat where
children can be properly restrained.
If you ever have to carry a group of
children, and a child must ride in
front:

05/06/03

09:29:52

31SDA630

0041

Protecting Children − General Guidelines, Protecting Infants and Small Children
Use childproof door locks to
prevent children from opening the
doors. This can prevent children

from accidentally falling out (see
page 78 ).
Do not leave children alone in a
vehicle. Leaving children without

adult supervision is illegal in most
states and Canadian provinces,
and can be very hazardous.
For example, infants and small
children left in a vehicle on a hot
day can die from heatstroke. A
child left alone with the key in the
ignition can accidentally set the
vehicle in motion, possibly injuring
themselves or others.

Lock all doors and the trunk when
your vehicle is not in use. Children

Protecting Infants

who play in vehicles can
accidentally get trapped inside.
Teach your children not to play in
or around vehicles. Know how to
operate the emergency trunk
opener and decide if your children
should be shown how to use this
feature (see page 83 ).
Keep vehicle keys and remote
transmitters out of the reach of
children. Even very young

children learn how to unlock
vehicle doors, turn on the ignition
switch, and open the trunk, which
can lead to accidental injury or
death.

Child Seat Type

An infant must be properly
restrained in a rear-facing, reclining
child seat until the child reaches the
seat maker’s weight or height limit
for the seat and the child is at least
one year old.
Only a rear-facing child seat provides
proper support for a baby’s head,
neck, and back.

38

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/06/03

09:29:59

31SDA630

0042

Protecting Infants and Small Children

Do not put a rear-facing child seat in
a forward-facing position. If placed

facing forward, an infant could be
very seriously injured during a
frontal collision.

Child Seat Placement

A rear-facing child seat can be placed
in any seating position in the back
seat, but not in the front. Never put a
rear-facing child seat in the front
seat.

If the passenger’s front airbag
inflates, it can hit the back of the
child seat with enough force to kill or
seriously injure an infant.
When properly installed, a rearfacing child seat may prevent the
driver or a front passenger from
moving their seat as far back as
recommended, or from locking their
seat-back in the desired position.

In any of these situations, we
strongly recommend that you install
the child seat directly behind the
front passenger’s seat, move the seat
as far forward as needed, and leave it
unoccupied. Or, you may wish to get
a smaller rear-facing child seat.

Placing a rear-facing child seat
in the front seat can result in
serious injury or death during a
collision.
Always place a rear-facing child
seat in the back seat, not the
front.

It could also interfere with proper
operation of the passenger’s
advanced front airbag system.

39

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Driver and Passenger Safety

Two types of seats may be used: a
seat designed exclusively for infants,
or a convertible seat used in the rearfacing, reclining mode.

05/06/03

09:30:07

31SDA630

0043

Protecting Infants and Small Children
Protecting Small Children

We also recommend that a small
child use the child seat until the child
reaches the weight or height limit
for the seat.

Child Seat Placement

We strongly recommend placing a
forward-facing child seat in a back
seat, not the front.
Placing a forward-facing child seat in
the front seat of a vehicle equipped
with a passenger’s airbag can be
hazardous. If the vehicle seat is too

far forward, or the child’s head is
thrown forward during a collision, an
inflating airbag can strike the child
with enough force to cause very
serious or fatal injuries.
Child Seat Type

A child who is at least 1 year old, and
who fits within the child seat maker’s
weight and height limits, should be
restrained in a forward-facing,
upright child seat.

Even with advanced front airbags,
which can automatically turn the
passenger’s front airbag off (see
page 27 ), a back seat is the safest
place for a small child.

Of the different seats available, we
recommend those that have a fivepoint harness system as shown.

40

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/06/03

09:30:16

31SDA630

0044

Protecting Infants and Small Children, Selecting a Child Seat
Selecting a Child Seat
When buying a child seat, you need
to choose either a conventional child
seat, or one designed for use with
the lower anchors and tethers for
children (LATCH) system.

Placing a forward-facing child
seat in the front seat can result
in serious injury or death if the
front airbag inflates.

Conventional child seats must be
secured to a vehicle with a seat belt,
whereas LATCH-compatible seats
are secured by attaching the seat to
hardware built into the two secondrow seats.

In seating positions and vehicles not
equipped with LATCH, a LATCHcompatible child seat can be installed
using a seat belt.
Whatever type of seat you choose, to
provide proper protection, a child
seat should meet three
requirements:
1. The child seat should meet U.S. or
Canadian Motor Vehicle Safety
Standard 213. Look for FMVSS

213 or CMVSS 213 on the box.
If you must place a forwardfacing child seat in front, move
the vehicle seat as far back as
possible, and properly restrain
the child.

Since LATCH-compatible child seats
are easier to install and reduce the
possibility of improper installation,
we recommend selecting this style.

2. The child seat should be of the
proper type and size to fit the child.

Rear-facing for infants, forwardfacing for small children.

We also recommend selecting a
LATCH-compatible seat with a rigid,
rather than a flexible, anchor (see
page 43 ).
CONTINUED

41

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Driver and Passenger Safety

If it is necessary to put a forwardfacing child seat in the front, move
the vehicle seat as far to the rear as
possible, and be sure the child seat is
firmly secured to the vehicle and the
child is properly strapped in the seat.

05/06/03

09:30:24

31SDA630

0045

Selecting a Child Seat, Installing a Child Seat
3. The child seat should fit the
vehicle seating position (or
positions) where it will be used.

Before purchasing a conventional
child seat, or using a previously
purchased one, we recommend that
you test the seat in the specific
vehicle seating position, or positions,
where the seat will be used.

Installing a Child Seat
After selecting a proper child seat
and a good place to install the seat,
there are three main steps in
installing the seat:
1. Properly secure the child seat to
the vehicle. All child seats must be
secured to the vehicle with the lap
part of a lap/shoulder belt or with
the LATCH (lower anchors and
tethers for children) system. A
child whose seat is not properly
secured to the vehicle can be
endangered in a crash.
2. Make sure the child seat is firmly
secured. After installing a child
seat, push and pull the seat
forward and from side-to-side to
verify that it is secure.
A child seat secured with a seat belt
should be installed as firmly as
possible. However, it does not need
to be ‘‘rock solid.’’ Some side-to-side

42

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

movement can be expected and
should not reduce the child seat’s
effectiveness.
If the child seat is not secure, try
installing it in a different seating
position, or use a different style of
child seat that can be firmly secured.
3. Secure the child in the child seat.
Make sure the child is properly
strapped in the child seat
according to the child seat maker’s
instructions. A child who is not
properly secured in a child seat
can be seriously injured in a crash.
The following pages provide
guidelines on how to properly install
a child seat. A forward-facing child
seat is used in all examples, but the
instructions are the same for rearfacing child seats.

05/06/03

09:30:32

31SDA630

0046

Installing a Child Seat

The lower anchors are located
between the seat-back and seat
bottom, and are to be used only with
a child seat designed for use with
LATCH.
LOWER ANCHOR MARKS

The location of each lower anchor is
indicated by a small button above the
anchor point.

To install a LATCH-compatible child
seat:
1. Move the seat belt buckle or
tongue away from the lower
anchors.
2. Make sure there are no objects
near the anchors that could
prevent a secure connection
between the child seat and the
anchors.

Rigid type

3. Place the child seat on the vehicle
seat, then attach the seat to the
lower anchors according to the
child seat maker’s instructions.
Some LATCH-compatible seats
have a rigid-type connection as
shown above.

43

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Driver and Passenger Safety

Installing a Child Seat with
LATCH
Your vehicle is equipped with
LATCH (lower anchors and tethers
for children) at the outer rear seats.

05/06/03

09:30:39

31SDA630

0047

Installing a Child Seat
TETHER STRAP HOOK

Flexible type

Other LATCH-compatible seats
have a flexible-type connection as
shown above.
4. Whatever type you have, follow
the child seat maker’s instructions
for adjusting or tightening the fit.

ANCHOR

5. Lift the head restraint (see page
87 ), then route the tether strap
through the legs of the head
restraint, making sure the strap is
not twisted.
6. Attach the tether strap hook to the
tether anchor, then tighten the
strap as instructed by the child
seat maker.

44

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

7. Push and pull the child seat
forward and from side-to-side to
verify that it is secure.

05/06/03

09:30:45

31SDA630

0048

Installing a Child Seat

In addition, the lap/shoulder belts in
all seating positions except the
driver’s have a locking mechanism
that must be activated to secure a
child seat.
1. With the child seat in the desired
seating position, route the belt
through the child seat according
to the seat maker’s instructions,
then insert the latch plate into the
buckle.

2. To activate the lockable retractor,
slowly pull the shoulder part of the
belt all the way out until it stops,
then let the belt feed back into the
retractor.
3. After the belt has retracted, tug on
it. If the belt is locked, you will not
be able to pull it out. If you can pull
the belt out, it is not locked, and
you will need to repeat these steps.

45

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Driver and Passenger Safety

Installing a Child Seat with a Lap/
Shoulder Belt
When not using the LATCH system,
all child seats must be secured to the
vehicle with the lap part of a lap/
shoulder belt.

05/06/03

09:30:51

31SDA630

0049

Installing a Child Seat
To deactivate the locking
mechanism and remove a child seat,
unlatch the buckle, unroute the seat
belt, and let the belt fully retract.

4. After confirming that the belt is
locked, grab the shoulder part of
the belt near the buckle, and pull
up to remove any slack from the
lap part of the belt. Remember, if
the lap part of the belt is not tight,
the child seat will not be secure.

5. Push and pull the child seat
forward and from side-to-side to
verify that it is secure enough to
stay upright during normal driving
maneuvers. If the child seat is not
secure, unlatch the belt, allow it to
retract fully, then repeat these
steps.

To remove slack, it may help to
put weight on the child seat, or
push on the back of the seat while
pulling up on the belt.

46

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/06/03

09:31:01

31SDA630

0050

Installing a Child Seat
Installing a Child Seat with a
Tether

Using an Outer Anchor
TETHER STRAP HOOK

A child seat with a tether can be
installed in any seating position in
the back seat, using one of the
anchorage points shown above.
Since a tether can provide additional
security to the lap/shoulder belt
installation, we recommend using a
tether whenever one is required or
available.

ANCHOR

1. After properly securing the child
seat (see page 43 ), lift the head
restraint, then route the tether
strap through the head restraint
legs.
2. Lift the anchor cover, then attach
the tether strap hook to the
anchor, making sure the strap is
not twisted.
3. Tighten the strap according to the
seat maker’s instructions.

TETHER STRAP HOOK

Driver and Passenger Safety

TETHER ANCHORAGE POINTS

Using the Center Anchor

ANCHOR

1. After properly securing the child
seat (see page 45 ), route the
tether strap through the head
restraint, and over the seat-back.
2. Follow steps 2 and 3 from the
previous column.

47

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/06/03

09:31:09

31SDA630

0051

Protecting Larger Children
When a child reaches the
recommended weight or height limit
for a forward-facing child seat, the
child should sit in a back seat on a
booster seat and wear a lap/shoulder
belt.

Allowing a child age 12 or under
to sit in front can result in injury
or death if the passenger’s front
airbag inflates.

The following pages give
instructions on how to check proper
seat belt fit, what kind of booster
seat to use if one is needed, and
important precautions for a child
who must sit in front.

If a larger child must ride in front,
move the vehicle seat as far
back as possible, use a booster
seat if needed, have the child
sit up properly and wear the
seat belt properly.

Checking Seat Belt Fit

To determine if a lap/shoulder belt
properly fits a child, have the child
put on the seat belt, then ask
yourself:
1. Does the child sit all the way back
against the seat?
2. Do the child’s knees bend
comfortably over the edge of the
seat?

48

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/06/03

09:31:17

31SDA630

0052

Protecting Larger Children
3. Does the shoulder belt cross
between the child’s neck and arm?

Using a Booster Seat

5. Will the child be able to stay
seated like this for the whole trip?
If you answer yes to all these
questions, the child is ready to wear
the lap/shoulder belt correctly. If
you answer no to any question, the
child needs to ride on a booster seat.

If a child who uses a booster seat
must ride in front, move the vehicle
seat as far to the rear as possible,
and be sure the child is wearing the
seat belt properly.
A child who has outgrown a forwardfacing child seat should ride in a
back seat and use a booster seat
until the lap/shoulder belt fits them
properly without the booster.

A child may continue using a booster
seat until the tops of the ears are
even with the top of the seat-back. A
child of this height should be tall
enough to use the lap/shoulder belt
without a booster.

Some states also require children to
use a booster seat until they reach a
given age or weight (e.g., 6 years or
60 lbs). Be sure to check current
laws in the state or states where you
intend to drive.

49

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Driver and Passenger Safety

4. Is the lap part of the belt as low as
possible, touching the child’s
thighs?

Booster seats can be high-back or
low-back. Whichever style you select,
make sure the booster meets federal
safety standards (see page 41 ) and
that you follow the booster seat
maker’s instructions.

05/06/03

09:31:27

31SDA630

0053

Protecting Larger Children
When Can a Larger Child Sit in
Front
The National Highway Traffic Safety
Administration and Transport
Canada recommend that all children
age 12 and under be properly
restrained in a back seat.
If the passenger’s front airbag
inflates in a moderate to severe
frontal collision, the airbag can cause
serious injuries to a child who is
unrestrained, improperly restrained,
sitting too close to the airbag, or out
of position.
A side airbag also poses risks. If any
part of a larger child’s body is in the
path of a deploying side airbag, the
child could receive possibly serious
injuries.

Of course, children vary widely. And
while age may be one indicator of
when a child can safely ride in front,
there are other important factors you
should consider.
Physical Size

Physically, a child must be large
enough for the lap/shoulder belt to
properly fit (see page 48 ). If the seat
belt does not fit properly, with or
without the child sitting on a booster
seat, the child should not sit in front.

If you decide that a child can safely
ride up front, be sure to:
Carefully read the owner’s manual,
and make sure you understand all
seat belt instructions and all safety
information.
Move the vehicle seat to the rearmost position.
Have the child sit up straight, back
against the seat, and feet on or
near the floor.

Maturity

To safely ride in front, a child must
be able to follow the rules, including
sitting properly, and wearing the seat
belt properly throughout a ride.

50

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Check that the child’s seat belt is
properly and securely positioned.
Supervise the child. Even mature
children sometimes need to be
reminded to fasten the seat belts
or sit properly.

05/06/03

09:31:32

31SDA630

0054

Protecting Larger Children
Additional Safety Precautions
Do not let a child wear a seat belt
across the neck. This could result

Do not let a child put the shoulder
part of a seat belt behind the back
or under the arm. This could

improve a child’s comfort or
reposition the shoulder part of a
seat belt can make the belt less
effective and increase the chance
of serious injury in a crash.

Driver and Passenger Safety

in serious neck injuries during a
crash.

Do not put any accessories on a
seat belt. Devices intended to

cause very serious injuries during
a crash. It also increases the
chance that the child will slide
under the belt in a crash and be
injured.
Two children should never use the
same seat belt. If they do, they

could be very seriously injured in a
crash.

51

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/06/03

09:31:39

31SDA630

0055

Carbon Monoxide Hazard
Your vehicle’s exhaust contains
carbon monoxide gas. You should
have no problem with carbon
monoxide entering the vehicle in
normal driving if you maintain your
vehicle properly.
Have the exhaust system inspected
for leaks whenever:

Carbon monoxide gas is toxic.
Breathing it can cause
unconsciousness and even kill
you.
Avoid any enclosed areas or
activities that expose you to
carbon monoxide.

The vehicle is raised for an oil
change.
You notice a change in the sound
of the exhaust.
The vehicle was in an accident
that may have damaged the
underside.

High levels of carbon monoxide can
collect rapidly in enclosed areas,
such as a garage. Do not run the
engine with the garage door closed.
Even with the door open, run the
engine only long enough to move the
vehicle out of the garage.

52

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

With the trunk open, airflow can pull
exhaust gas into your vehicle’s
interior and create a hazardous
condition. If you must drive with the
trunk open, open all the windows and
set the climate control system as
shown below.
If you must sit in your parked vehicle
with the engine running, even in an
unconfined area, adjust the climate
control system as follows:
1. Select the fresh air mode.
mode.
2. Select the
3. Turn the fan on high speed.
4. Set the temperature control to a
comfortable setting.

05/06/03

09:32:11

31SDA630

0056

Safety Labels

HOOD

DASHBOARD

U.S. models

U.S. models only

SUN VISOR
U.S. models

Driver and Passenger Safety

These labels are in the locations
shown. They warn you of potential
hazards that could cause serious
injury or death. Read these labels
carefully. If a label comes off or
becomes hard to read (except for the
U.S. dashboard label which is
removed by the owner), contact your
dealer for a replacement.

Canadian models

DOORJAMBS
U.S. models

Canadian models

Canadian models

RADIATOR
CAP

53

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/06/03

09:32:19

31SDA630

0058

Instruments and Controls
This section gives information about
the controls and displays that
contribute to the daily operation of
your vehicle. All the essential
controls are within easy reach.

Driver’s Lumbar Support ............ 85
Front Seat Adjustments .............. 86
Driver’s Seat Manual Height
Adjustment ............................... 86
Driver’s Seat Power Height
Adjustment ............................... 87
Head Restraints ........................... 87
Folding Rear Seat ........................ 88
Mirrors .............................................. 90
Adjusting the Power Mirrors ..... 90
Power Windows ............................... 91
Power Window Control
Operations ................................ 93
Moonroof .......................................... 94
Parking Brake .................................. 95
Sun Visor........................................... 96
Vanity Mirror ................................... 96
Interior Lights .................................. 97
Ceiling Light ................................. 97
Individual Interior Lights............ 97
Interior Convenience Items ............ 98
Beverage Holders ........................ 99
Accessory Power Sockets........... 99
Console Compartment ................ 99
Sunglasses Holder ..................... 100
Glove Box ................................... 100

55

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Instruments and Controls

Control Locations ............................ 56
Instrument Panel ............................. 57
Instrument Panel Indicators ........... 58
Gauges .............................................. 64
Odometer/Outside
Temperature Display .............. 64
Odometer ...................................... 64
Outside Temperature Display.... 64

Trip Meter .................................... 65
Temperature Gauge .................... 65
Fuel Gauge ................................... 66
Check Fuel Cap Indicator ........... 66
Controls Near the Steering
Wheel ............................................ 67
Wipers and Washers ....................... 68
Turn Signal and Headlights............ 69
Automatic Lighting Off
Feature .......................................... 70
Daytime Running Lights................. 70
Instrument Panel Brightness ......... 71
Hazard Warning ............................... 71
Rear Window Defogger .................. 72
Steering Wheel Adjustment ........... 73
Keys and Locks ................................ 74
Immobilizer System......................... 75
Ignition Switch ................................. 76
Door Locks ....................................... 77
Childproof Door Locks ................... 78
Remote Transmitter ........................ 78
Trunk................................................. 82
Emergency Trunk Opener ......... 83
Seat Heaters ..................................... 84
Seats .................................................. 85
Power Seat Adjustment .............. 85

05/06/03

09:32:25

31SDA630

0059

Control Locations
INDICATORS (P.58)
GAUGES (P.64)

CRUISE CONTROLS (P.145)
HAZARD WARNING
BUTTON
(P.71)

MOONROOF SWITCH
(P.94)

AUDIO SYSTEM
(P.114)

MIRROR CONTROLS
(P.90)

HEATING/COOLING
CONTROLS
(P.102)
CLIMATE CONTROL
SYSTEM
(P.109)

POWER DOOR LOCK
MASTER SWITCH
(P.77)

SHIFT LEVER
(P.170, 173)

TRUNK RELEASE LEVER
HOOD RELEASE
(P.82)
HANDLE
PARKING BRAKE LEVER
FUEL FILL DOOR RELEASE LEVER (P.157)
(P.95)
(P.156)

56

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

ACCESSORY POWER SOCKETS
(P.99)

05/06/03

09:32:33

31SDA630

0060

Instrument Panel
VSA ACTIVATION INDICATOR (P.60)
IMMOBILIZER SYSTEM INDICATOR (P.63)
LIGHTS-ON INDICATOR (P.61)

VEHICLE STABILITY ASSIST (VSA)
SYSTEM INDICATOR (P.60)

LOW FUEL INDICATOR (P.61)

CRUISE CONTROL INDICATOR (P.63)
ANTI-LOCK BRAKE SYSTEM
(ABS) INDICATOR (P.59)
DOOR AND TRUNK
OPEN MONITOR (P.60)

MAINTENANCE MINDER
INDICATOR (P.63)
SEAT BELT
REMINDER LIGHT (P.58)

CHARGING SYSTEM
INDICATOR (P.58)
LOW OIL PRESSURE
INDICATOR (P.58)

SUPPLEMENTAL
RESTRAINT SYSTEM
INDICATOR (P.59)
HIGH BEAM INDICATOR (P.62)
PARKING BRAKE AND BRAKE SYSTEM
INDICATOR (P.59)
DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHTS INDICATOR (P.62)

SEC URITY SYSTEM INDICATOR (P.62)
SIDE AIRBAG OFF INDICATOR (P.59)

The U.S. instrument panel is shown. Differences for the Canadian models are noted in the text.

57

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Instruments and Controls

MALFUNCTION
INDICATOR LAMP (P.58)

CRUISE CONTROL MAIN
INDICATOR (P.63)

05/06/03

09:32:42

31SDA630

0061

Instrument Panel Indicators
The instrument panel has many
indicators to give you important
information about your vehicle.
Seat Belt Reminder
Indicator
This indicator comes on when you
turn the ignition switch to the ON
(II) position. It reminds you and your
passengers to fasten your seat belts.
A beeper also sounds if you and your
front passenger have not fastened
your seat belts.

If your front passenger does not
fasten their seat belt, the indicator
comes on about 6 seconds after the
ignition switch is turned to the ON
(II) position.
If either of you do not fasten your
seat belt while driving, the beeper
will sound and the indicator will flash
again at regular intervals. For more
information, see page 20 .

If you turn the ignition switch to the
ON (II) position before fastening
your seat belts, the beeper sounds,
and the indicator flashes. If you do
not fasten your seat belts before the
beeper stops, the indicator stops
flashing but remains on.

Low Oil Pressure
Indicator
The engine can be severely damaged
if this indicator flashes or stays on
when the engine is running. For
more information, see page 250 .
Charging System
Indicator
If this indicator comes on when the
engine is running, the battery is not
being charged. For more information,
see page 251 .
Malfunction Indicator
Lamp
See page 251 .

58

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/06/03

09:32:53

31SDA630

0062

Instrument Panel Indicators
Parking Brake and Brake System
Indicator
U.S.

Canada

1. It comes on when you turn the
ignition switch to the ON (II)
position. It is a reminder to check
the parking brake. A beeper
sounds if you try to drive with the
parking brake not fully released.
Driving with the parking brake not
fully released can damage the
brakes and tires.
2. If it remains lit after you fully
release the parking brake while
the engine is running, or if it
comes on while driving, there
could be a problem with the brake
system. For more information, see
page 253 .

U.S.

Canada

Side Airbag Off
Indicator
This indicator comes on when you
turn the ignition switch to the ON
(II) position. If it comes on at any
other time, it indicates that the
passenger’s side airbag has
automatically shut off. For more
information, see page 31 .
Anti-lock Brake System
(ABS) Indicator
This indicator normally comes on for
a few seconds when you turn the
ignition switch to ON (II), and when
the ignition switch is turned to
START (III). If it comes on at any
other time, there is a problem with
the ABS. If this happens, have your
vehicle checked at a dealer. With
this on, your vehicle still has normal
braking ability but no anti-lock
brakes. For more information, see
page 180 .

59

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Instruments and Controls

This indicator has two functions:

Supplemental Restraint
System Indicator
This indicator comes on briefly when
you turn the ignition switch to the
ON (II) position. If it comes on at
any other time, it indicates a
potential problem with your front
airbags. This indicator will also alert
you to a potential problem with your
side airbags, passenger’s side airbag
automatic cutoff system, side curtain
airbags, automatic seat belt
tensioners, driver’s seat position
sensor, or the front passenger’s
weight sensors. For more
information, see page 30 .

05/06/03

16:43:37

31SDA630

0063

Instrument Panel Indicators
Vehicle Stability Assist
(VSA) System Indicator
This indicator normally comes on for
a few seconds when you turn the
ignition switch to the ON (II)
position.
If it comes on and stays on at any
other time, or if it does not come on
when you turn the ignition switch to
ON (II), there is a problem with the
VSA system. Take your vehicle to a
dealer to have it checked. Without
VSA, your vehicle still has normal
driving ability, but will not have VSA
traction and stability enhancement.
See page 182 for more information
on the VSA system.

VSA Activation Indicator

Door and Trunk Open Monitor

This indicator normally comes on for
a few seconds when you turn the
ignition switch to ON (II). For more
information, see page 182 .
This indicator has three functions:
1. It comes on as a reminder that you
have turned off the vehicle
stability assist (VSA) system.
2. It flashes when VSA is active (see
page 182 ).
3. It comes on along with the VSA
system indicator if there is a
problem with the VSA system.

60

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

The appropriate indicator comes on
in this monitor if the trunk or either
door is not closed tightly.
All the indicators in the monitor
come on for a few seconds when you
turn the ignition switch to ON (II).

05/06/03

09:33:11

31SDA630

0064

Instrument Panel Indicators
Lights On Indicator

Low Fuel Indicator

This indicator reminds you that the
exterior lights are on. It comes on
when the light switch is in either the
or
position. If you turn the
ignition switch to the ACCESSORY
(I) or the LOCK (0) position without
turning off the light switch, this
indicator will remain on. A reminder
chime will also sound when you open
the driver’s door.
LOW FUEL INDICATOR

When you turn on the Hazard
Warning button, both turn signal
indicators blink. All turn signals on
the outside of the vehicle should
flash.

This indicator is located in the fuel
gauge. It comes on as a reminder
that you must refuel soon.
When the indicator comes on, there
are about 2.72 U.S. gal (10.3 ) of
fuel remaining in the tank before the
needle reaches E. There is a small
reserve of fuel remaining in the tank
when the needle does reach E.

61

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Instruments and Controls

Turn Signal and
Hazard Warning
Indicators
The left or right turn signal indicator
blinks when you signal a lane change
or turn. If the indicators do not blink,
or if they blink rapidly, it usually
means one of the turn signal bulbs is
burned out (see pages 221 and 222 ).
Replace the bulb as soon as possible,
since other drivers cannot see that
you are signaling.

05/06/03

09:33:18

31SDA630

0065

Instrument Panel Indicators
Security System Indicator
U.S. EX, EX-L, LX-V6 and EX-V6
Canadian SE, EX-L, SE-V6 and EX-V6
SECURITY SYSTEM INDICATOR

‘‘Daytime Running
Lights’’ Indicator
If this indicator comes on when the
ignition switch is turned to the ON
(II) position and the parking brake is
released, it means there is a problem
in the high beam headlight’s circuit.
Have your vehicle checked by your
dealer.

This indicator comes on when the
security system is set. See page
144 for more information on the
security system.

62

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

High Beam Indicator
This indicator comes on with the
high beam headlights. For more
information, see page 70 .
When the daytime running lights
(DRL) are on, this indicator comes
on with reduced brightness.

05/07/01

10:05:16

31SDA630

0066

Instrument Panel Indicators
Cruise Control Main
Indicator
Only on models equipped with Cruise
Control System

Cruise Control Indicator
Only on models equipped with Cruise
Control System

This indicator comes on when you
set the cruise control. See page
145 for information on operating the
cruise control.

Immobilizer System
Indicator
This indicator comes on for a few
seconds when you turn the ignition
switch to the ON (II) position. It will
go off if you have inserted a
properly-coded ignition key. If it is
not a properly-coded key, the
indicator will blink and the engine
will not start (see page 75 ).

This indicator goes off when your
dealer resets it after completing the
required maintenance service.

This indicator also blinks several
times when you turn the ignition
switch from the ON (II) position to
the ACCESSORY (I) or the LOCK
(0) position.
Washer Level Indicator
Canadian models only

This indicator comes on when the
washer fluid level is low. Add washer
fluid when you see this indicator
come on (see page 208 ).

63

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Instruments and Controls

This indicator comes on when you
turn on the cruise control master
button (see page 145 ).

Maintenance Minder
Indicator
This indicator reminds you that it is
time to take your vehicle in for
scheduled maintenance. The
maintenance main items and sub
items will be displayed in the
information display. See page 193 for
more information on the
maintenance minder.

05/06/03

09:33:40

31SDA630

0067

Gauges
TACHOMETER

Outside Temperature Display

SPEEDOMETER
FUEL GAUGE
TEMPERATURE
GAUGE

ODOMETER/OUTSIDE
TEMPERATURE INDICATOR
U.S. model shown

Odometer/Outside Temperature
Display
The odometer and the outside
temperature display use the same
display. To switch the display
between the odometer and the
outside temperature, press the
Select/Reset knob. When you turn
the ignition switch to ON (II), what
you last selected is displayed.

TRIP METER

SELECT/RESET KNOB

Odometer
The odometer shows the total
distance your vehicle has been
driven. It measures miles in U.S.
models and kilometers in Canadian
models. It is illegal under U.S.
federal law and Canadian provincial
regulations to disconnect, reset, or
alter the odometer with the intent to
change the number of miles or
kilometers indicated.

64

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

EX-L and EX-V6

This display shows the outside
temperature in Fahrenheit (U.S.
models) or Centigrade (Canadian
models). To see the outside
temperature, press and release the
Select/Reset knob until the
temperature is displayed.
The temperature sensor is in the
front bumper. Therefore, the
temperature reading can be affected
by heat reflection from the road
surface, engine heat, and the
exhaust from surrounding traffic.
This can cause an incorrect
temperature reading when your
speed is under 19 mph (30 km/h).
The sensor delays the display update
until it reaches the correct outside
temperature. This may take several
minutes.

05/06/03

09:33:49

31SDA630

0068

Gauges
Trip Meter
This meter shows the number of
miles (U.S.) or kilometers (Canada)
driven since you last reset it.

NOTE: The temperature must be
stabilized before doing this
procedure.

There are two trip meters: Trip A
and Trip B. Switch between these
displays and the odometer/outside
temperature display by pressing the
Select/Reset knob repeatedly. Each
trip meter works independently, so
you can keep track of two different
distances.

Select the outside temperature
display, then press the Select/Reset
knob for 10 seconds. The following
sequences appear, 1 second at a
time: 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, −5, −4, −3, −2,
−1, 0, 1 (0, 1, 2, 3, −3, −2, −1, 0, 1).
When the temperature reaches the
desired value, release the Select/
Reset knob. You should see the new
outside temperature displayed.

When you turn the ignition switch to
ON (II), what you last selected is
displayed.

Temperature Gauge
This shows the temperature of the
engine’s coolant. During normal
operation, the pointer should rise
from the bottom white mark to about
the middle of the gauge. In severe
driving conditions, such as very hot
weather or a long period of uphill
driving, the pointer may rise into the
upper half of the gauge. If it reaches
the red (Hot) mark, pull safely to the
side of the road. Turn to page 248 for
instructions and precautions on
checking the engine’s cooling
system.

To reset a trip meter, display it, and
then press and hold the Select/Reset
knob until the number resets to ‘‘0.0’’.

In certain weather conditions,
temperature readings near freezing
(32°F, 0°C) could mean that ice is
forming on the road surface.

65

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Instruments and Controls

If the outside temperature is
incorrectly displayed, you can adjust
it up to ±5°F (±3°C) warmer or
cooler.

05/07/01

10:05:26

31SDA630

0069

Gauges
Fuel Gauge
This shows how much fuel you have.
It may show slightly more or less
than the actual amount. The needle
returns to the bottom after you turn
off the ignition.

Avoid driving with an extremely low
f uel level. Running out of f uel could
cause the engine to misf ire, damaging
the catalytic converter.

Check Fuel Cap Indicator
(odometer/outside temperature
message)
If your fuel cap is loose or missing, a
‘‘CHECK FUEL CAP’’ message will
appear in the odometer/outside
temperature display. As soon as it is
safely possible, turn the engine off
and check that the fuel cap is
installed. If it is, loosen the cap and
tighten it 1 click. Although you can
use the Select/Reset button to cycle
the fuel cap warning off of the
display, it will be displayed again
each time the engine is started. It
will take several days of normal
driving for the vehicle to turn the
warning off.
If the vehicle on board diagnostic
system continues to detect a
problem, the Malfunction Indicator
Lamp (MIL) will illuminate. If the
MIL does not go off, have your
dealer inspect the vehicle. For more
information, see page 251 .

66

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Maintenance Minder Display
The information display in the
instrument panel shows you the
engine oil life and maintenance
service items when the ignition
switch is in the ON (II) position. This
information helps to keep you aware
of the periodic maintenance your
vehicle needs for continued troublefree driving. Refer to page 193 for
more information.

05/06/03

09:34:01

31SDA630

0070

Controls Near the Steering Wheel

INSTRUMENT PANEL
BRIGHTNESS
(P.71)

WINDSHIELD
WIPERS/WASHERS
(P.68)

PASSENGER AIRBAG
OFF INDICATOR
(P.31)

Instruments and Controls

HEADLIGHTS/
TURN SIGNALS
(P.69)
HAZARD
WARNING BUTTON
(P.71)

REMOTE AUDIO
CONTROLS
(P.141)

CRUISE CONTROLS
(P.145)

VOICE CONTROL
SWITCHES*

REAR WINDOW
DEFOGGER
(P.72, 108)

MOONROOF
SWITCH
(P.94)

VSA OFF SWITCH
(P.181)

STEERING WHEEL
ADJUSTMENT
(P.73)

HORN

* : Only on vehicles equipped with navigation system. Refer to the navigation system manual.

67

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/06/03

09:34:09

31SDA630

0071

Wipers and Washers
Windshield Wiper

Push the right lever up or down to
select a position.

LO − The wipers run at low speed.
HI − The wipers run at high speed.

MIST − The wipers run at high
speed until you release the lever.
OFF − The wipers are not activated.
INT − The length of the wiper
interval is varied automatically
according to the vehicle’s speed.
Except U.S. VP

1. MIST
2. OFF
3. INT − Intermittent
4. LO − Low speed
5. HI − High speed
6. Windshield washers

Vary the delay by turning the INT
TIME ring. If you turn it to the
shortest delay, the wipers will
change to low speed operation when
the vehicle speed exceeds 12 mph
(20 km/h).

68

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Windshield Washer − Pull the
wiper control lever toward you, and
hold it. The washers spray until you
release the lever. The wipers run at
low speed, then complete one more
sweep after you release the lever.

05/06/03

09:34:16

31SDA630

0072

Turn Signal, Headlights
Turn Signal and Headlights

Headlights − Turning the switch
on the left lever to the
position
turns on the parking lights, taillights,
side marker lights, rear license plate
lights and lights-on indicator.
Turning the switch to the
position turns on the
headlights. If you leave the lights on
with the ignition switch in
ACCESSORY (I) or LOCK (0), you
will hear a reminder chime when you
open the driver’s door.

High Beams − To turn on the high
beams, push the lever forward until
you hear a click. The blue high beam
indicator will come on (see page 62 ).
To turn off the high beams, pull the
lever back. To flash the high beams,
pull the lever farther back, and then
release it. The high beams remain on
until the lever is released.

When the light switch is in either of
these positions, the lights-on
indicator comes on as a reminder.

69

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Instruments and Controls

1. Turn signal
2. Off
3. Parking and interior lights
4. Headlight on
5. High beams
6. Flash high beams

Turn Signal − Push down on the
left lever to signal a left turn and up
to signal a right turn. To signal a lane
change, push lightly on the lever in
the proper direction and hold it. The
lever will return to center when you
release it or complete a turn.

05/06/03

09:34:23

31SDA630

0073

Automatic Lighting Off Feature, Daytime Running Lights
Automatic Lighting Off Feature
Except U.S. VP and Canadian DX-G

This feature turns off the headlights,
parking lights, side marker lights,
taillights, and rear license plate lights
within 15 seconds of removing the
key from the ignition switch and
closing the driver’s door.
This feature activates if you leave
the headlight switch in the
or
position, remove the key, then
open and close the driver’s door.

If you remove the key from the
ignition switch with the headlight
switch on, but do not open the door
and get out, the lights will turn off
after 10 minutes.
The lights will turn on again when
you unlock or open the driver’s door.
If you unlock the door, but do not
open it within 15 seconds, the lights
will go off. With the driver’s door
open, you will hear a lights-on
reminder chime.

70

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Daytime Running Lights
With the headlight switch off, the
high beam headlights and the high
beam indicator come on with
reduced brightness when you turn
the ignition switch to the ON (II)
position and release the parking
brake. They remain on until you turn
the ignition switch off, even if you
set the parking brake.
The headlights revert to normal
operation when you turn them on
with the switch.

05/06/03

09:34:31

31SDA630

0074

Instrument Panel Brightness, Hazard Warning
Instrument Panel Brightness

brightness when you turn the
ignition switch to ON (II).

Hazard Warning

SELECT/RESET KNOB

The Select/Reset knob on the
instrument panel controls the
brightness of the instrument panel
lights. Turn the knob to adjust the
brightness.
The instrument panel will illuminate
with reduced brightness when you
unlock and open the driver’s door.
The brightness will increase slightly
when you insert the key in the
ignition switch, then go to normal

If you insert the key but do not turn
the ignition switch to ON (II), the
illumination turns off in about 10
seconds.
To reduce glare at night, the instrument panel illumination dims when
you turn the light switch to
or
. Turning the Select/Reset
knob fully to the right until you hear
a click will cancel the reduced brightness.

U.S. model shown

Push the button between the center
vents to turn on the hazard warning
lights (four-way flashers). This
causes all four outside turn signals
and both turn indicators in the
instrument panel to flash. Use the
hazard warning lights if you need to
park in a dangerous area near heavy
traffic, or if your vehicle is disabled.

71

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Instruments and Controls

If you do not insert the key in the
ignition switch after opening the
driver’s door, the illumination turns
off about 30 seconds after you close
the door.

05/06/07

17:18:50

31SDA630

0075

Rear Window Defogger

Manual A/C type shown

The rear window defogger will clear
fog, frost, and thin ice from the
window. Push the defogger button to
turn it on and off. The indicator
above/in the button comes on to
show the defogger is on. It also shuts
off when you turn off the ignition
switch. You have to turn the
defogger on again when you restart
the vehicle.

Auto A/C type shown

Make sure the rear window is clear
and you have good visibility before
starting to drive.

72

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Vehicles with navigation system

The defogger and antenna wires on
the inside of the rear window can be
accidentally damaged. When
cleaning the glass, always wipe side
to side.

05/06/03

09:34:42

31SDA630

0076

Steering Wheel Adjustment
Make any steering wheel adjustment
before you start driving.

2. Push the lever under the steering
column all the way down.

Adjust the steering wheel only
when the vehicle is stopped.
3. Move the steering wheel up or
down, and in or out to the desired
position. Make sure you can see
the instrument panel gauges and
the indicator lights.

73

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Instruments and Controls

Adjusting the steering wheel
position while driving may
cause you to lose control of the
vehicle and be seriously injured
in a crash.

1. Insert the key in the ignition
switch, and unlock the steering
column.

05/06/03

09:34:50

31SDA630

0077

Steering Wheel Adjustment, Keys and Locks
4. Push the lever up to lock the
steering wheel in that position.
5. Make sure you have securely
locked the steering wheel in place
by trying to move it up, down, in,
and out.

Keys and Locks
MASTER
VALET KEY
KEY
NUMBER KEY WITH (LIGHT GREY)
REMOTE
TAG
TRANSMITTER

You should have received a key
number tag with your keys. You will
need this key number if you ever
have to get a lost key replaced. Use
only Honda-approved key blanks.
These keys contain electronic
circuits that are activated by the
immobilizer system. They will not
work to start the engine if the
circuits are damaged.

The master key fits all the locks on
your vehicle. The valet key works
only in the ignition and the door
locks. You can keep the trunk
release handle, rear seat trunk
access, and glove box locked when
you leave your vehicle and the valet
key at a parking facility.

74

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Protect the keys from direct
sunlight, high temperature, and
high humidity.
Do not drop the keys or set heavy
objects on them.
Keep the keys away from liquids.
If they get wet, dry them
immediately with a soft cloth.

05/06/03

09:34:57

31SDA630

0078

Immobilizer System
The immobilizer system protects
your vehicle from theft. If an
improperly-coded key (or other
device) is used, the engine will not
start.

Do not attempt to alter this system
or add other devices to it. Electrical
problems could result that may make
your vehicle undriveable.
If you lose your key and you cannot
start the engine, contact your dealer.

As required by the FCC:
This device complies with Part 15 of the
FCC rules. Operation is subject to the
following two conditions: (1) This device
may not cause harmful interference, and
(2) this device must accept any
interference received, including
interference that may cause undesired
operation.
Changes or modifications not expressly
approved by the party responsible for
compliance could void the user’s
authority to operate the equipment.
This device complies with Industry
Canada Standard RSS-210.
Operation is subject to the following two
conditions: (1) this device may not cause
interference, and (2) this device must
accept any interference that may cause
undesired operation of the device.

The system may not recognize your
key’s coding if another immobilizer
key or other metal object (i.e. key
fob) is near the ignition switch when
you insert the key.

75

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Instruments and Controls

When you turn the ignition switch to
the ON (II) position, the immobilizer
system indicator should come on for
a few seconds, then go out. If the
indicator starts to blink, it means the
system does not recognize the
coding of the key. Turn the ignition
switch to the LOCK (0) position,
remove the key, reinsert it, and turn
the ignition switch to the ON (II)
position again.

If the system repeatedly does not
recognize the coding of your key,
contact your dealer.

05/06/03

09:35:03

31SDA630

0079

Ignition Switch
LOCK (0) − You can insert or
remove the key only in this position.
To turn the key, the shift lever must
be in Park, and you must push the
key in slightly. If the front wheels
are turned, the anti-theft lock may
make it difficult to turn the key.
Firmly turn the steering wheel to the
left or to the right as you turn the
key.

ACCESSORY (I) − You can
operate the audio system and the
accessory power sockets in this
position.
ON (II) − This is the normal key
position when driving. Several of the
lights on the instrument panel come
on as a test when you turn the
ignition switch from ACCESSORY
(I) to ON (II).
START (III) − Use this position
only to start the engine. The switch
returns to the ON (II) position when
you let go of the key.

The ignition switch has four
positions: LOCK (0), ACCESSORY
(I), ON (II), START (III).

76

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/06/03

09:35:10

31SDA630

0080

Ignition Switch, Door Locks
Door Locks
POWER DOOR LOCK MASTER SWITCH
top
bottom

To lock any passenger’s door when
getting out of the vehicle, push the
lock tab down, and close the door.

If your vehicle has an automatic
transmission, the shift lever must be
in Park before you can remove the
key from the ignition switch.

Removing the key from the
ignition switch while driving
locks the steering. This can
cause you to lose control of the
vehicle.

Each door has a lock tab on it. Push
down the tab to lock the door and
pull it up to unlock. When you push
down the tab on the driver’s door, all
the doors lock.

Each front door has a power door
lock master switch. Either switch
locks and unlocks all doors. Push the
top of the switch to lock all doors;
push the bottom to unlock them.

All doors can be locked from the
outside by using the key in the
driver’s door. To unlock only the
driver’s door, insert the key, turn it
clockwise, and release it. The
remaining doors unlock when you
turn the key a second time within a
few seconds.

Remove the key from the
ignition switch only when
parked.

77

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Instruments and Controls

You will hear a reminder beeper if
you leave the key in the ignition
switch in the LOCK (0) or
ACCESSORY (I) position and open
the driver’s door. Remove the key to
turn off the beeper.

05/06/03

09:35:18

31SDA630

0081

Door Locks
Lockout Prevention

With the driver’s door open and the
key in the ignition, both door lock
switches are disabled. They are not
disabled if the driver’s door is closed.
Pushing the switch down on the
open passenger’s door will lock all
doors.

Childproof Door Locks
LEVER

The childproof door locks are
designed to prevent children seated
in the rear from accidentally opening
the rear doors. Each rear door has a
lock lever near the edge. With the
lever in the LOCK position, the door
cannot be opened from the inside
regardless of the position of the lock
tab. To open the door, pull the lock
tab up, and use the outside door
handle.

78

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Remote Transmitter
PANIC
BUTTON

UNLOCK
BUTTON

TRUNK
RELEASE
BUTTON

LOCK
BUTTON

LOCK − Press this button once to
lock all doors. Some exterior and
interior lights will flash. The doors
do not lock if they are not fully
closed or the key is in the ignition
switch.

05/06/03

09:35:24

31SDA630

0082

Childproof Door Locks, Remote Transmitter
U.S. EX, EX-L, LX-V6 and EX-V6
Canadian SE, EX-L, SE-V6 and EX-V6

UNLOCK − Press this button once
to unlock the driver’s door. Push it
twice to unlock the other doors.
The ceiling light (if the ceiling light
switch is in the center position) will
come on when you press the
UNLOCK button. If you do not open
any door, the light stays on for about
30 seconds, then fades out. If you
relock the doors with the remote
transmitter before 30 seconds have
elapsed, the light will go off
immediately.

If you unlock the doors with the
remote transmitter, but do not open
any of the doors within 30 seconds,
the doors automatically relock.
U.S. EX, EX-L, LX-V6 and EX-V6
Canadian SE, EX-L, SE-V6 and EX-V6

After the doors automatically relock,
the security system will be active.

PANIC − Press this button for
about 1 second to attract attention;
the horn will sound and the exterior
lights will flash for about 30 seconds.
To cancel panic mode, press any
other button on the remote
transmitter, or turn the ignition
switch to the ON (II) position.
TRUNK − Press this button for
about 1 second to open the trunk.
You cannot open the trunk if the key
is in the ignition switch.

79

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Instruments and Controls

When you push LOCK twice within 5
seconds, you will hear a beep to
verify that the security system is
active.

You cannot lock the doors with the
remote transmitter if they are not
fully closed or the key is in the
ignition switch.

05/06/03

09:35:33

31SDA630

0083

Remote Transmitter
Remote Transmitter Care

Avoid dropping or throwing the
transmitter.
Protect the transmitter from
extreme temperature.

Replacing the Transmitter Battery

If it takes several pushes on the
button to lock or unlock the doors,
replace the battery as soon as
possible.
Battery type: CR1616

Do not immerse the transmitter in
any liquid.
If you lose a transmitter, the
replacement needs to be
reprogrammed by your dealer.

SCREW

To replace the battery:
1. Remove the screw at the base of
the transmitter with a small
Phillips-head screwdriver.
2. Separate the transmitter by prying
its middle seam with your
fingernail.

80

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/06/03

09:35:40

31SDA630

0084

Remote Transmitter

BATTERY

5. Install the parts in reverse order.

As required by the FCC:
This device complies with Part 15 of the
FCC rules. Operation is subject to the
following two conditions: (1) This device
may not cause harmful interference, and
(2) this device must accept any
interference received, including
interference that may cause undesired
operation.
Changes or modifications not expressly
approved by the party responsible for
compliance could void the user’s
authority to operate the equipment.

TAB

3. Inside the transmitter, separate
the inner cover from the keypad
by releasing the two tabs on the
cover.

This device complies with Industry
Canada Standard RSS-210.
Operation is subject to the following two
conditions: (1) this device may not cause
interference, and (2) this device must
accept any interference that may cause
undesired operation of the device.

81

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Instruments and Controls

4. Remove the old battery from the
back of the inner cover, and note
the polarity. Make sure the
polarity of the new battery is the
same (+ side facing down), then
insert it into the back of the cover.

05/07/01

10:05:37

31SDA630

0085

Trunk

Pull

To close the trunk, press down on
the trunk lid.
See page 165 for cargo loading and
weight limit information. Keep the
trunk lid closed at all times while
driving to avoid damaging the lid,
and to prevent exhaust gas from
getting into the interior. See Carbon
Monoxide Hazard on page 52 .
MASTER
KEY

TRUNK RELEASE LEVER

To protect items in the trunk when
you need to give the key to someone
else:

You can open the trunk in either of
the following ways:
Pull up on the trunk release lever
located to the left of the driver’s
seat.
Press and hold the trunk release
button on the remote transmitter.

1. Lock the trunk release lever with
the master key. Also make sure
the trunk pass-through cover is
locked (see page 89 ).
2. Give the person the valet key.

82

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/06/03

09:35:53

31SDA630

0086

Trunk
Emergency Trunk Opener

To open the trunk, push the release
lever to the left.
For more information about child
safety, see page 38 .
Instruments and Controls

As a safety feature, your vehicle has
a release lever on the trunk latch so
the trunk can be opened from the
inside.

83

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/06/03

09:35:59

31SDA630

0087

Seat Heaters
After the seat reaches a comfortable
temperature, select LO by pushing
the back of the switch. This will keep
the seat warm.
In HI, the heater turns off when the
seat gets warm, and turns back on
after the seat temperature drops.
In LO, the heater runs continuously.
It does not cycle with temperature
changes.
U.S. EX-L and EX-V6
Canadian EX-L and EX-V6

Both front seats are equipped with
seat heaters. Because of the sensors
for the side airbag system, there is
no heater in the passenger’s seatback. The ignition switch must be
ON (II) to use the heaters.

84

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Follow these precautions whenever
you use the seat heaters:
Use the HI setting only to heat the
seats quickly, because it draws
large amounts of current from the
battery.
If the engine is left idling for an
extended period, do not use the
seat heaters even on the LO
setting. It can weaken the battery,
causing hard starting.

05/06/03

09:36:10

31SDA630

0088

Seats
Driver’s Lumbar Support

U.S. EX, EX-L, LX-V6 and EX-V6
Canadian EX-L, SE-V6 and LX-V6
See pages 13 − 14 for important safety
information and warnings about how to
properly position seats and seat-backs.

U.S. EX, EX-L and EX-V6
Canadian EX-L and EX-V6

The controls for the adjustable
driver’s power seat are on the
outside edge of the seat bottom. You
can adjust the power seat with the
ignition switch in any position. Make
all seat adjustments before you start
driving.
U.S. EX-V6
Canadian EX-V6

The passenger’s seat has two
switches. One moves the seat
forward and backward, and the other
raises and lowers the seat.

Instruments and Controls

Power Seat Adjustment

Moves the seat
forward and backward.
Moves the front of the
seat up or down and
the rear of the seat up
or down.
Raises or lowers the
seat.

To change the lumbar support, move
the lever on the right side of the
seat-back forward or backward.
Keep moving the lever forward or
backward until you find a suitable
position.

Adjusts the seat-back
angle forward or
backward.

85

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/06/03

09:36:17

31SDA630

0089

Seats
Front Seat Adjustments

Driver’s Seat Manual Height
Adjustment
U.S. VP and SE
Canadian DX-G and SE

To adjust the seat forward or
backward, pull up on the bar under
the seat cushion’s front edge. Move
the seat to the desired position, and
release the bar. Try to move the seat
to make sure it is locked in position.

To change the seat-back angle, pull
up on the lever on the outside of the
seat bottom.
The height of your driver’s seat is
adjustable. To raise the seat bottom,
repeatedly pull up the lever on the
outside of the seat cushion. To lower
the seat, push the lever down
repeatedly.

86

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/06/03

09:36:26

31SDA630

0090

Seats
Driver’s Seat Power Height
Adjustment

They are most effective when you
adjust them so the back of the
occupant’s head rests against the
center of the restraint.

Head Restraints

U.S. EX
Canadian EX-L, SE-V6 and EX-V6

RELEASE BUTTON

See page 15 for important safety
information and a warning about how to
properly position the head restraints.

The height of your driver’s seat is
power adjustable. Pull up on the
switch to raise the seat. Push it down
to lower the seat.
Make all adjustments before you
start driving.

Your vehicle is equipped with head
restraints in all seating positions to
help protect you and your
passengers from whiplash and other
injuries.

87

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Instruments and Controls

The front and rear head restraints
adjust for height. You need both
hands to adjust the restraint. Do not
attempt to adjust it while driving. To
raise it, pull upward. To lower the
restraint, push the release button
and push the restraint down.

05/06/03

09:36:33

31SDA630

0091

Seats
Folding Rear Seat
MASTER KEY

Pull

GUIDE

The back of the rear seat folds down,
giving you direct access to the trunk.
The seat-back can be released from
inside the vehicle or inside the trunk.

When storing cargo, you can move
the rear center shoulder belt out of
the way by removing the belt from
the guide.

To release the seat-back from inside
the trunk, pull the release loop under
the trunk panel.
To lock the seat-back upright, push it
firmly against the trunk panel. Make
sure it is latched in place by pulling
on the top of the seat.

To fold down the seat-back from
inside the vehicle, insert the master
key in the lock on the rear shelf.
Turn the key clockwise, pull down
the top of the seat-back, then release
the key.

88

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/06/03

09:36:41

31SDA630

0092

Seats
Make sure all rear shoulder belts are
positioned in front of the rear seatback whenever the seat-back is in its
upright position.

Trunk Pass-through Cover
KEY CYLINDER

KNOB

Never drive with this cover open and
the trunk lid open.
See Carbon Monoxide Hazard on
page 52 .

LID

Never drive with the seat-back
folded down and the trunk lid open.
See Carbon Monoxide Hazard on
page 52 .

Except U.S. VP and Canadian DX-G

The trunk pass-through cover can be
opened from either side; it folds
forward onto the center armrest.
Open the cover by sliding the knob
downward and pushing or pulling on
the cover. To close the cover, swing
it up and push firmly on the top.
Make sure it latches properly.
Make sure all items in the trunk and
those extending through the passthrough are secured.

89

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Instruments and Controls

Make sure all items in the trunk, or
items extending through the opening
into the back seat, are secured.
Loose items can fly forward and
cause injury if you have to brake
hard. See Carrying Cargo on page
164 .

For security, this cover can be
locked and unlocked only with the
master key. To lock the cover, insert
the key and turn it clockwise.

05/06/03

09:36:49

31SDA630

0093

Mirrors
Adjusting the Power Mirrors
Except U.S. VP and Canadian DX-G

4. When you finish, turn the
adjustment knob to the center
(off) position. This turns off the
adjustment knob to keep your
settings.

TAB

Keep the inside and outside mirrors
clean and adjusted for best visibility.
Be sure to adjust the mirrors before
you start driving.
The outside mirrors are manually
adjustable.
The inside mirror has day and night
positions. The night position reduces
glare from headlights behind you.
Flip the tab on the bottom edge of
the mirror to select the day or night
position.

3. Push or pull the adjustment knob
right, left, up, or down to move the
mirror.

ADJUSTMENT KNOB

1. Turn the ignition switch to the ON
(II) position.
2. Turn the adjustment knob to L
(driver’s side) or R (passenger’s
side).

90

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/06/03

09:36:56

31SDA630

0094

Mirrors, Power Windows
Power Mirror Heaters

Power Windows

Except U.S. VP and LX, and
Canadian DX-G

Closing a power window on
someone’s hands or fingers can
cause serious injury.

HEATED MIRROR BUTTON

DRIVER’S WINDOW
SWITCH

The outside mirrors are heated to
remove fog and frost. With the
ignition switch in the ON (II)
position, turn on the heaters by
pressing the button. The indicator in
the button comes on as a reminder.
Press the button again to turn the
heaters off.

MAIN SWITCH

Turn the ignition switch to ON (II)
to raise or lower any window, push
the switch down and hold it. Release
the switch when you want the
window to stop. Close the window by
pulling the switch up and holding it.

AUTO − To open the driver’s
window, push the window switch
firmly down, then release it. To stop
the window from going all the way
down, pull back on the window
switch briefly.
To close the driver’s window fully,
pull back the window switch firmly,
then release it. To stop the window
from going all the way up, push
down on the window switch briefly.

91

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Instruments and Controls

Make sure your passengers are
away from the windows before
closing them.

05/06/03

09:37:03

31SDA630

0095

Power Windows
To open or close the driver’s window
partially, push down or pull back on
the window switch lightly and hold it.
The window will stop when you
release the switch.
The passenger windows cannot be
raised or lowered if the MAIN switch
is OFF. Keep the MAIN switch off
when you have children in the
vehicle so they do not injure
themselves by operating the
windows unintentionally.

AUTO REVERSE − If the driver’s
window senses any obstacle while it
is closing automatically, it will
reverse direction, and then stop. To
close the window, remove the
obstacle, then use the window switch
again.

If your vehicle’s battery is
disconnected or goes dead, or the
driver’s window fuse is removed, the
AUTO function will be disabled. The
power window system needs to be
reset after reconnecting the battery
or installing the fuse.

Auto reverse stops sensing when the
window is almost closed. You should
always check that all passengers and
objects are away from the window
before closing it.

1. Start the engine. Push down and
hold the driver’s window switch
until the window is fully open.
2. Pull and hold the driver’s window
switch to close the window
completely, then hold the switch
for a second or two more.
If the power windows do not operate
properly after resetting, have your
vehicle checked by your dealer.

92

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/06/03

09:37:14

31SDA630

0096

Power Windows
Power Window Control
Operations

UNLOCK BUTTON

Opening the Windows with the
Remote Transmitter

You can open all of the windows
from the outside with the remote
transmitter.
1. Press the UNLOCK button once
to unlock the driver’s door.
2. Press the UNLOCK button a
second time, and hold it. The
passenger’s doors unlock, and all
four windows start to open. To
stop the windows, release the
button.
3. To open the windows further,
press the button again.
You cannot close the windows with
the remote transmitter.

Open
Close

Opening/Closing the Windows with
the Key

You can open and close the windows
with the key in the driver’s door lock.
To open:
1. Insert the key in the driver’s door
lock.
2. Turn the key clockwise, then
release it.

93

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Instruments and Controls

The power window system has a keyoff delay function. The windows will
still operate for up to 10 minutes
after you turn off the ignition switch.
Opening either front door cancels
the delay function. You must turn
the ignition switch to ON (II) again
before you can raise or lower the
windows.

05/06/03

09:37:24

31SDA630

0097

Power Windows, Moonroof
3. Turn the key clockwise again, and
hold it. All four windows start to
open. To stop the windows,
release the key.

To tilt up the back of the moonroof,
press and hold the center button
. To close the moonroof, press
and hold the upper button
. To
open the moonroof, press and hold
the lower button
. Release the
button when the moonroof gets to
the desired position. Make sure
everyone’s hands are away from the
moonroof before opening or closing
it.

Moonroof

4. To open the windows further, turn
and hold the key again.
To close:
1. Insert the key in the driver’s door
lock.
2. Turn the key counterclockwise,
then release it.
3. Turn the key counterclockwise
again, and hold it. All four
windows start to close. To stop the
windows, release the key.
4. To close the windows further, turn
and hold the key again.

MOONROOF SWITCH

U.S. EX, EX-L, LX-V6 and EX-V6
Canadian SE, EX-L, SE-V6 and EX-V6

The moonroof has two positions: it
can be tilted up in the back for
ventilation, or it can be slid back into
the roof. Use the switch under the
left dashboard vent to operate the
moonroof. The ignition switch must
be in the ON (II) position.

94

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Opening or closing the
moonroof on someone’s hands
or fingers can cause serious
injury.
Make sure all hands and fingers
are clear of the moonroof
before opening or closing it.

05/06/03

09:37:30

31SDA630

0098

Moonroof, Parking Brake

If you try to open the moonroof in
below-f reezing temperatures, or when
it is covered with snow or ice, you can
damage the moonroof panel or motor.

Parking Brake
Driving the vehicle with the parking
brake applied can damage the rear
brakes and hubs.
Instruments and Controls

The moonroof has a key-off delay
function. You can still open and close
the moonroof for up to 10 minutes
after you turn off the ignition switch.
The key-off delay function cancels as
soon as you open either front door.
You must then turn the ignition
switch to ON (II) to operate the
moonroof.

PARKING BRAKE LEVER

To apply the parking brake, pull the
lever up fully. To release it, pull up
slightly, push the button, and lower
the lever. The parking brake light on
the instrument panel should go out
when the parking brake is fully
released with the engine running
(see page 59 ).

95

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/06/03

09:37:36

31SDA630

0099

Sun Visor, Vanity Mirror
Sun Visor

Vanity Mirror

To use the sun visor, pull it down.
You can also use the sun visor at the
side window. Remove the support
rod from the clip and swing the sun
visor toward the side window.

To use a vanity mirror on the back of
the sun visor, pull up the cover.
Except U.S. VP and
Canadian DX-G

The vanity mirror lights come on
when you pull up the cover.

96

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/06/03

09:37:45

31SDA630

0100

Interior Lights
Ceiling Light

U.S. LX, SE and LX-V6
Canadian SE and SE-V6
DOOR ACTIVATED

DOOR ACTIVATED

OFF

COURTESY LIGHT

The ceiling lights have a three or
two-position switch; ON (for threeposition), Door Activated, and OFF.
In the Door Activated (center or left)
position, the lights come on when
you:
Open any door.
Unlock the doors with the key or
remote transmitter.
After all doors are closed tightly, the
light dims slightly, then fades out in
about 30 seconds.

U.S. EX, EX-L and EX-V6
Canadian EX-L and EX-V6

The front ceiling light also contains
two spotlights. Push the spotlight
lenses to turn them on and off.

Individual Interior Lights
The courtesy light in each door
comes on when you open that door.
The light around the ignition switch
only comes on when you open the
driver’s door. After you close the
door, the ignition switch light fades
out in about 30 seconds.
In the U.S. VP and the Canadian DXG, the front doors do not have
courtesy lights.

The courtesy light between the
spotlights comes on when you turn
the parking lights on. To adjust its
brightness, turn the Select/Reset
knob on the instrument panel.

97

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Instruments and Controls

ON

Push on the spotlight lenses to turn
the light on and off.

05/06/03

09:37:49

31SDA630

0101

Interior Convenience Items

CONSOLE COMPARTMENT and
ACCESSORY POWER SOCKET

FRONT DOOR POCKET and
BEVERAGE HOLDER

CENTER POCKET,
COIN POCKET and
ACCESSORY POWER SOCKET

BEVERAGE HOLDER

REAR DOOR POCKET

GLOVE BOX

BEVERAGE HOLDERS

TRUNK

SEAT-BACK POCKETS

98

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/06/03

09:37:58

31SDA630

0102

Interior Convenience Items

Spilled liquids can damage the
upholstery, carpeting, and electrical
components in the interior.
Accessory Power Sockets
Except U.S. VP and Canadian DX-G

These sockets are intended to supply
power for 12 volt DC accessories
that are rated 120 watts or less (10
amps). None of the sockets will
power an automotive type cigarette
lighter element. When more than
one socket is being used, the
combined power rating of the
accessories should be 120 watts or
less (10 amps).

Console Compartment
RIGHT LEVER

LEFT LEVER

CONSOLE COMPARTMENT

To open the console compartment,
pull up on the right lever and lift the
armrest.
To close, lower the armrest, and
push it down until it latches.

You can put small items in the tray
located in the console compartment
lid. To use the tray, pull up on the
left lever and lift up the armrest.
Except U.S. VP and Canadian DX-G

The console compartment is
equipped with a coin holder.

99

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Instruments and Controls

Beverage Holders
Be careful when you are using the
beverage holders. A spilled liquid
that is very hot can scald you or your
passengers. Liquid can also spill
from the door pocket beverage
holders when you close the doors.
Use only resealable containers in the
door pockets.

05/06/03

09:38:05

31SDA630

0103

Interior Convenience Items
Sunglasses Holder

Glove Box
An open glove box can cause
serious injury to your passenger
in a crash, even if the
passenger is wearing the seat
belt.
Always keep the glove box
closed while driving.

GLOVE BOX

Except U.S. VP and Canadian DX-G

To open the sunglasses holder, push
on the front edge. Make sure the
holder is closed while you are driving.

Open the glove box by pulling the
handle to the left. Close it with a firm
push. Lock or unlock the glove box
with the master key.
The glove box light comes on when
the parking lights are on.

100

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/06/03

09:38:11

31SDA630

0104

Features
The heating and air conditioning
system in your vehicle provides a
comfortable driving environment in
all weather conditions.

U.S. EX, EX-L, LX-V6 and EX-V6
Canadian EX-L, SE-V6 and EX-V6

Your vehicle has an anti-theft audio
system that requires a code number
to enable it.
U.S. EX, EX-L, LX-V6 and EX-V6
Canadian EX-L, SE-V6 and EX-V6

The security system helps to discourage vandalism and theft of your
vehicle.

Tape Search Functions ............. 133
Caring for the Tape and
Player ...................................... 134
Playing the XMTM Satellite
Radio ....................................... 135
Satellite Digital Radio ................ 135
To Play XMTM Satellite Radio.... 136
To Select a Channel................... 136
Satellite Radio Signals ............... 138
Receiving Satellite Radio
Service..................................... 139
Steering Wheel Controls .............. 141
Radio Theft Protection.................. 142
Setting the Clock ........................... 143
Security System ............................. 144
Cruise Control ................................ 145
HomeLink Universal
Transceiver................................. 148

101

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Features

The standard audio system has
many features. This section describes those features and how to
use them.

Vents, Heating, and A/C .............. 102
Voice Control System................ 104
Dual Temperature Control ........... 111
Climate Control Sensors ............... 113
Playing the Radio ........................... 114
Voice Control System................ 116
To Play the Radio ...................... 116
To Select a Station ..................... 116
Adjusting the Sound .................. 119
Radio Frequencies ..................... 120
Radio Reception ......................... 120
Playing a CD ................................... 122
Playing a CD, CD Changer ........... 124
To Play a CD .............................. 124
To Stop Playing a CD ................ 127
Removing CDs from the
Changer .................................. 127
Operating the Optional CD
Changer .................................. 128
CD Player Error Messages .......... 129
Protecting your CDs...................... 130
General Information .................. 130
Protecting CDs........................... 130
Playing a Tape ................................ 131
To Play a Tape ........................... 132
To Stop Playing a Tape ............. 132

05/06/03

09:38:17

31SDA630

0105

Vents, Heating, and A/C
U.S. VP, LX, SE, EX and LX-V6
Canadian DX-G, SE and SE-V6
FAN CONTROL DIAL

U.S. EX-L and EX-V6 without Navigation System
Canadian EX-L and EX-V6 without Navigation System

RECIRCULATION BUTTON

TEMPERATURE DISPLAY

TEMPERATURE
CONTROL DIAL

AIR
CONDITIONING
BUTTON

FAN SPEED
INDICATOR

TEMPERATURE
CONTROL DIAL
(DRIVER’S SIDE)

REAR WINDOW
DEFOGGER
BUTTON
WINDSHIELD
DEFROST BUTTON

TEMPERATURE
CONTROL DIAL
(PASSENGER’S SIDE)

MODE
BUTTON
FAN CONTROL
BUTTONS

AIR
CONDITIONING
BUTTON

AUTO BUTTON
MAX A/C BUTTON

MODE BUTTONS
OFF BUTTON
DUAL BUTTON

REAR WINDOW
DEFOGGER BUTTON
WINDSHIELD
DEFROST BUTTON

RECIRCULATION BUTTON

102

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/06/03

09:38:22

31SDA630

0106

Vents, Heating, and A/C
U.S. EX-L and EX-V6 with Navigation System
Canadian EX-L and EX-V6 with Navigation System
TEMPERATURE DISPLAY

Features

A/C BUTTON
AIR CONDITIONING ICONS
MODE ICONS
FAN CONTROL ICONS

TEMPERATURE CONTROL
BUTTONS (DRIVER’S SIDE)

TEMPERATURE CONTROL
BUTTONS (PASSENGER’S SIDE)
AUTO BUTTON

REAR WINDOW DEFOGGER BUTTON
WINDSHIELD DEFROST BUTTON

OFF BUTTON
DUAL BUTTON

RECIRCULATION BUTTON

103

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/06/03

09:38:32

31SDA630

0107

Vents, Heating, and A/C
Voice Control System
Only on models equipped with
Navigation System

The climate control system for your
vehicle can also be operated using
the voice control system. See the
Navi section in your Quick Start
Guide for an overview of this system,
and the Navigation System manual
for complete details.
Fan Control
U.S. VP, LX, SE, EX and LX-V6
Canadian DX-G, SE and SE-V6

Turn this dial to increase or decrease
the fan speed and airflow.

EX-L and EX-V6 without Navigation
System

You can manually select the fan
speed by pressing the A/C button
next to the display and then,
pressing the fan control icons.
Temperature Control
Except EX-L and EX-V6 with Navigation
System

Turning this dial clockwise increases
the temperature of the airflow.
EX-L and EX-V6

The driver and passenger can select
independent temperature settings by
selecting the DUAL button.

EX-L and EX-V6 with Navigation System

You can manually select the fan
speed by pressing the fan control
buttons. The fan speed is
represented by vertical bars in the
display.

EX-L and EX-V6 with Navigation System

Press the DUAL button. The
indicator in the button will come on.
The driver and passenger can each
select the temperature control
buttons ( ▲ or ▼ ) to the
desired setting.

EX-L and EX-V6 without Navigation
System

Push the DUAL button. When the
indicator in the button is on, turn the
dials to adjust the temperature.

104

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

EX-L and EX-V6

When the indicator in the DUAL
button is off, both sides adjust to the
driver’s side temperature.

05/06/03

09:38:42

31SDA630

0108

Vents, Heating, and A/C
Air Conditioning (A/C) Button

EX-L and EX-V6

Except EX-L and EX-V6

When the A/C is off, the airflow
temperature does not fall below the
outside air temperature. When you
set the airflow temperature lower
than the outside air temperature,
make sure the A/C is on.

Press the A/C button to turn the
air conditioning on or off. The
indicator in the button is on when
the air conditioning is on.

The outside air intakes for the
heating and cooling system are at
the base of the windshield. Keep this
area clear of leaves and other debris.

Press the A/C button to turn the air
conditioning on and off. The display
shows ‘‘A/C ON’’ when the air
conditioning is on. The display
shows ‘‘A/C OFF’’ when the air
conditioning is off.

The system should be left in fresh
air mode under almost all conditions.
Keeping the system in recirculation
mode, particularly with the A/C off,
can cause the windows to fog up.
Switch to recirculation mode when
driving through dusty or smoky
conditions, then return to fresh air
mode.

EX-L and EX-V6 with Navigation
System

The display shows ‘‘ON’’ and ‘‘OFF’’
after you press the A/C button. The
display shows ‘‘A/C ON’’ after you
touch ‘‘ON’’ to turn the air
conditioning on. The display shows
‘‘A/C OFF’’ after you touch ‘‘OFF’’ to
turn the air conditioning off.

Rear Window Defogger Button
This button turns the rear window
defogger off and on (see page 72 ).

105

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Features

EX-L and EX-V6 without Navigation
System

Recirculation Button
When the recirculation indicator is
on, air from the vehicle’s interior is
sent throughout the system again.
When the indicator is off, air is
brought in from the outside of the
vehicle (fresh air mode).

05/06/03

09:38:57

31SDA630

0109

Vents, Heating, and A/C
Mode Control
Use the mode control buttons or
icons to select the vents the air flows
from. Some air flows from the
dashboard corner vents in all modes.

When you select
or
,
the system automatically switches to
Fresh Air mode and turns on the
A/C. In these modes, the A/C stays
on with the indicator off.

Air flows from the center
and corner vents in the dashboard.

When you select
, the system
automatically switches to fresh air
mode.

Airflow is divided between
the vents in the dashboard and the
floor vents.
Air flows from the floor
vents.
Airflow is divided between
the floor vents and the defroster
vents at the base of the windshield.
Air flows from the defroster
vents at the base of the windshield.

EX-L and EX-V6 without Navigation
System

Each time you press the MODE
button, the display shows the mode
selected.
EX-L and EX-V6 with Navigation
System

Press the A/C button to view the
display, then touch any of the mode
icons on the display.

106

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

MAX A/C Button
U.S. VP, SE, EX and LX-V6
Canadian DX-G, SE and SE-V6

The system automatically
turns on the A/C, selects
,
and switches to recirculation mode.
Each indicator above the button is on
when the MAX A/C is turned on.
Ventilation
The flow-through ventilation system
draws in outside air, circulates it
through the interior, then exhausts it
through vents near the rear window.
1. Set the temperature to the lower
limit.
2. Make sure the A/C is off.
and fresh air mode.
3. Select
4. Set the fan to the desired speed.

05/06/03

09:39:08

31SDA630

0110

Vents, Heating, and A/C
Using the Heater
The heater uses engine coolant to
warm the air. If the engine is cold, it
will be several minutes before you
feel warm air coming through the
system.

.
1. Select
When you select
, the system
automatically switches to the fresh
air mode.
2. Set the fan to the desired speed.
3. Adjust the warmth of the air with
the temperature control dial.
EX-L and EX-V6 with Navigation System

1. Press the A/C button, the manual
operation of A/C screen will
appear.
2. Select the desired mode and fan
speed icons on the display.
3. Adjust for warmth with the
temperature buttons (▲ or ▼).

Except EX-L and EX-V6 with Navigation
System

1. Turn on the A/C by pressing the
ON button. The indicator in the
button comes on when a fan speed
is selected.
2. Make sure the temperature
control dial or button is set to
maximum cool.
.
3. Select
4. If the outside air is humid, select
Recirculation mode. If the outside
air is dry, select Fresh Air mode.
5. Set the fan to the desired speed.

EX-L and EX-V6 with Navigation System

1. Press the A/C button, the Manual
Operation A/C screen will appear.
2. Select the ON icon on the display.
3. Select the desired temperature
and MODE selections. If the
outside air is humid, select the
Recirculation mode. If the outside
air is dry, select Fresh Air mode.
If the interior is very warm, you can
cool it down more rapidly by partially
opening the windows, turning on the
A/C, and setting the fan to
maximum speed in fresh air mode.
Except EX-L and EX-V6

To cool the interior with MAX A/C:
1. Set the fan to the desired speed.
2. Select the MAX A/C mode.
The system automatically turns on
the A/C, selects
and
switches to Recirculation mode.
3. Make sure the temperature
control dial is all the way to the left.

107

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Features

Except EX-L and EX-V6 with Navigation
System

Using the A/C
Air conditioning places an extra load
on the engine. Watch the engine
coolant temperature gauge (see page
65 ). If it moves near the red zone,
turn off the A/C until the gauge
reading returns to normal.

05/06/03

09:39:17

31SDA630

0111

Vents, Heating, and A/C
Dehumidify the Interior
Air conditioning, as it cools, removes
moisture from the air. When used in
combination with the heater, it
makes the interior warm and dry.
1. Turn the fan on.
2. If the A/C is off, turn it on (if
equipped).
and fresh air mode.
3. Select
4. Adjust the temperature control
dial or buttons to your preference.
This setting is suitable for all driving
conditions whenever the outside
temperature is above 32°F (0°C).

To Defog and Defrost
To remove fog from the inside of the
windows:
1. Set the fan to the desired speed, or
high for faster defrosting.
. The system
2. Select
automatically switches to fresh air
mode and turns on the A/C. The
A/C indicator will not come on if it
was previously off.
3. Adjust the temperature so the
airflow feels warm.
to help clear the
4. Select
rear window.
5. To increase airflow to the
windshield, close the corner vents.

108

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

When you switch to
, from
or
mode, the A/C
stays on whether the indicator is on
or off. This helps prevent the
windows from rapidly fogging up
when the air is suddenly routed away
from the windshield. If you want to
turn the A/C off, press and release
the A/C button until the indicator in
the button comes on and then goes
off.

05/06/03

09:39:25

31SDA630

0112

Vents, Heating, and A/C

To clear the windows faster, you can
close the dashboard corner vents by
rotating the wheel below each vent.
This sends more warm air to the
windshield defroster vents. Once the
windshield is clear, select fresh air
mode to avoid fogging the windows.

Automatic Climate Control

Press the AUTO button.

EX-L and EX-V6

Without Navigation System: Set the
desired temperature by turning
the Temperature Control dial. You
will see AUTO in the system’s
display.
With Navigation System: Set the
desired temperature by pressing
the ▲ to raise the temperature or
▼ to lower the temperature. The
selected temperature will show in
the upper display.

The automatic climate control
system adjusts the fan speed and
airflow levels to maintain the interior
temperature you select.
For Vehicles with Navigation System

In the AUTO mode, the vehicle’s
interior temperature is
independently regulated for the
driver and passenger. If the driver’s
side of the vehicle is getting too
much sun, the system will adjust to a
lower temperature.

For your safety, make sure you have
a clear view through all the windows
before driving.

109

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Features

To Remove Exterior Frost or Ice
From the Windows
. The system
1. Select
automatically switches to fresh air
mode and turns on the A/C. The
A/C indicator does not come on if
it was previously off.
.
2. Select
3. Set the fan and temperature
controls to maximum level.

05/06/03

09:39:37

31SDA630

0113

Vents, Heating, and A/C
The system automatically selects the
proper mix of conditioned and/or
heated air to raise or lower the
interior temperature to the
temperature you selected.
If you set the temperature to its
lowest limit, (Lo) or its highest limit,
(Hi) the system runs at full cooling
or heating only. It does not regulate
the interior temperature.
In cold weather, the fan will not
come on automatically until the
heater starts to develop warm air.
Dual Temperature Control − When
the indicator in the Dual button is on,
the driver’s side and passenger’s side
temperature can be controlled
independently (see page 111 ).

Manual Operation
You can manually select various
functions of the automatic climate
control system when it is in AUTO.
All other features remain
automatically controlled.
EX-L and EX-V6 without Navigation
System

Making any manual selection causes
the word AUTO in the display to go
out.
EX-L and EX-V6 with Navigation System

If you press the A/C button next to
the display, the manual selections
will show in the display. Making any
manual selection causes the
indicator in the AUTO button to turn
off.

To Turn Everything Off
Press the OFF button. However, a
lack of airflow can cause the
windows to fog up. You should keep
the fan on at all times so stale air and
moisture do not build up in the
interior and cause fogging.
If you press OFF, the climate control
system shuts off.
−Keep the system off for short
periods only.
−To keep stale air and mustiness
from collecting, you should have
the fan running at all times.
With Navigation System

When the Climate Control System is
turned OFF, the temperature in the
upper display will also turn off.
Except EX and EX-V6

Turning the fan speed control dial all
the way to the left shuts the system
off.

110

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/06/03

09:39:45

31SDA630

0114

Dual Temperature Control
EX-L and EX-V6
Without Navigation System

Without Navigation System

Your vehicle has two temperature
control dials, one for the driver, and
one for the front passenger.
With Navigation System

The driver’s side and the passenger’s
side can be controlled independently
by adjusting these dials or buttons
when the green indicator in the
DUAL button is lit.

PASSENGER’S SIDE
TEMPERATURE
CONTROL DIAL

DRIVER’S SIDE
TEMPERATURE
CONTROL DIAL
DUAL BUTTON

With Navigation System

Temperature Control Dials/Buttons

Push AUTO or
. The selected
temperatures appear in the upper
display. For vehicles with navigation
system, when the indicator in the
DUAL button is off, you can adjust
both sides to the same temperature
by adjusting the driver’s side
temperature control dial or buttons.

DRIVER’S SIDE
PASSENGER’S SIDE
TEMPERATURE
TEMPERATURE
CONTROL BUTTONS
CONTROL BUTTONS
DUAL BUTTON

CONTINUED

111

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Features

Your vehicle has four temperature
control buttons, two for the driver,
and two for the passenger.

05/06/03

09:39:50

31SDA630

0115

Dual Temperature Control
To set the driver’s side temperature
to a different value than the
passenger’s, press the DUAL button,
then turn the driver’s control dial or
press the ▲ or ▼ buttons on the
driver’s side. To set the passenger’s
side to a different value than the
driver’s, turn the passenger’s control
dial or press the ▲ or ▼ buttons on
the passenger’s side. You can adjust
the passenger’s side without
pressing the DUAL button first.

DRIVER’S SIDE

When you set the temperature to its
lower or upper limit, it is displayed as
or
.

112

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

PASSENGER’S SIDE

05/06/03

09:39:55

31SDA630

0116

Climate Control Sensors
Sunlight Sensor/Temperature
Sensor
If your vehicle has a climate control
system

TEMPERATURE SENSOR

SUNLIGHT SENSOR

Features

The climate control system has two
sensors. A sunlight sensor is in the
top of the dashboard, and a
temperature sensor is next to the
steering column. Do not cover the
sensors or spill any liquid on them.

113

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/06/03

09:40:02

31SDA630

0117

Playing the Radio
U.S. VP, LX, SE, EX and LX-V6
Canadian DX-G, SE and SE-V6

EX-L and EX-V6 without Navigation System

STEREO INDICATOR
AM/FM
BUTTON

STEREO INDICATOR
SCAN BUTTON

PRESET BARS

AM/FM
BUTTON
A.SEL
BUTTON

A.SEL
BUTTON

TUNE BAR

TUNE BAR

SEEK BAR

SEEK BAR

PRESET BARS

SOUND BUTTON

SOUND BUTTON

SCAN BUTTON

PWR/VOL KNOB

PWR/VOL KNOB

114

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/06/03

09:40:07

31SDA630

0118

Playing the Radio
EX-L and EX-V6 with Navigation System

STEREO INDICATOR

Features

UPPER
DISPLAY
AM/FM
BUTTON
AUDIO
DISPLAY
BUTTON

SCAN
BUTTON

PRESET
ICONS
SEEK BAR
TUNE/
SOUND
KNOB
PWR/VOL
KNOB

AUDIO
SELECT
ICON

SCAN
ICON

SOUND ICON

115

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/07/01

10:05:49

31SDA630

0119

Playing the Radio
Voice Control System
Only on models equipped with
Navigation System

The audio system for your vehicle
can also be operated using the voice
control system. See the Navi section
in your Quick Start Guide for an
overview of this system, and the
navigation system manual for
complete details.

To Play the Radio
The ignition switch must be in the
ACCESSORY (I) or the ON (II)
position. Turn the system on by
pushing the PWR/VOL knob or the
FM/AM button. Adjust the volume
by turning the PWR/VOL knob.
For Vehicles with Navigation System

Pushing the AUDIO DISPLAY
button will also turn on the system.
The band and frequency that the
radio was last tuned to is displayed.
To change bands, press the FM/AM
button. On the FM band, ST will be
displayed if the station is broadcasting in stereo. Stereo reproduction on
AM is not available.
XM satellite radio information is
available on page 135 .

116

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

To Select a Station
You can use any of five methods to
find radio stations on the selected
band: TUNE, SEEK, SCAN, AUTO
SELECT, and the preset bars or
icons.
TUNE − Use the TUNE bar or
knob to tune the radio to a desired
frequency. Press the
side of the
bar or turn the knob to the right to
tune to a higher frequency, and the
side or turn the knob to the left
to tune to a lower frequency.
SEEK − The seek function
searches up and down from the
current frequency to find a station
with a strong signal. To activate it,
press the
or
side of the
bar, then release it.

05/06/03

09:40:24

31SDA630

0120

Playing the Radio

If you do nothing, the system will
then scan for the next strong station
and play it for five seconds. When it
plays a station you want to listen to,
press the SCAN button again.

Preset − Each preset bar or icon
can store one frequency on AM, and
two frequencies on FM.
1. Select the desired band, AM or
FM. FM1 and FM2 let you store
two frequencies with each preset
bar or icon.
For Vehicles with Navigation System

3. Pick the preset number (1 − 6)
you want for that station. Press
the left or right side of the bar or
icon and hold it until you hear a
beep.
4. Repeat steps 1 through 3 to store a
total of six stations on AM and
twelve stations on FM.

Push the AUDIO DISPLAY button
to view the preset icons.
2. Use the TUNE, SEEK, or SCAN
function to tune the radio to a
desired station.

117

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Features

SCAN − The SCAN function
samples all stations with strong
signals on the selected band. To
activate it, press the SCAN button,
then release it. You will see SCAN in
the display. The system will scan for
a station with a strong signal. When
it finds one, it will stop and play that
station for about five seconds.

05/06/03

09:40:29

31SDA630

0121

Playing the Radio
The preset frequencies will be lost if
your vehicle’s battery goes dead, is
disconnected, or the radio fuse is
removed.

AUTO SELECT − If you are
traveling far from home and can no
longer receive your preset stations,
you can use the auto select feature to
find stations in the local area.
Press the A. SEL button or touch the
Auto Select icon. A. SEL will flash in
the display, and the system will go
into scan mode for several seconds.
It stores the frequencies of six AM,
and twelve FM stations in the preset
bars (1 − 6) or icons. You will see a
‘‘0’’ displayed after pressing a preset
bar or icon if Auto Select cannot find
a strong station for every preset bar
or icon.

118

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

If you do not like the stations Auto
Select has stored, you can store
other frequencies on the preset bars
or icons. Use the TUNE, SEEK, or
SCAN function to find stations, then
store them in the preset bars or
icons as described previously.
To turn off Auto Select, press the A.
SEL button or Auto Select icon. This
restores the presets you originally
set.

05/06/03

09:40:38

31SDA630

0122

Playing the Radio

Balance/Fader − These two
modes adjust the strength of the
sound coming from each speaker.
BAL adjusts the side-to-side strength,
while FAD adjusts the front-to-back
strength.
Treble/Bass − Use the TRE/BAS
modes to adjust the tone to your
liking.
For Vehicles with Navigation System

For Vehicles without Navigation System

Each mode is shown in the display as
it changes. Turn the VOLUME knob
or touch the icon to adjust the
setting to your liking. When the level
reaches the center, you will see ‘‘C’’
in the display.

The system will automatically return
the display to the selected audio
mode about five seconds after you
stop adjusting a mode. On vehicles
with navigation system, touch the
RETURN icon to go back to the
audio screen.
Features

Adjusting the Sound
Press the SOUND button or icon, or
press the TUNE knob repeatedly to
display the Bass (BAS), Treble
(TRE), Balance (BAL), and Fader
(FAD) settings. On vehicles with
navigation system, touch the
SOUND icon or press the TUNE
knob.

For Vehicles with Navigation System

Touch the arrows next to the BAS or
TRE icons. The adjustment shows
you the current setting.
Touch the left or right bars on the
sound grid. Balance is equalized
when the vertical lines are centered
on the grid.
Touch the front or rear bars on the
sound grid. The fader is equalized
when the horizontal lines are
centered on the grid.

If you want to adjust the sound while
the radio/CD is playing, push the
AUDIO DISPLAY button, then touch
the SOUND icon in the display.

119

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/06/03

09:40:46

31SDA630

0123

Playing the Radio
Radio Frequencies
The radio can receive the complete
AM and FM bands.
Those bands cover these frequencies:
AM band: 530 to 1,710 kilohertz
FM band: 87.7 to 107.9 megahertz
Radio stations on the AM band are
assigned frequencies at least 10
kilohertz apart (530, 540, 550).
Stations on the FM band are
assigned frequencies at least 0.2
megahertz apart (87.9, 88.1, 88.3).
Stations must use these exact
frequencies. It is fairly common for
stations to round-off the frequency in
their advertising, so your radio could
display a frequency of 100.9 even
though the announcer may identify
the station as ‘‘FM101.’’

Radio Reception
How well the radio receives stations
is dependent on many factors, such
as the distance from the station’s
transmitter, nearby large objects,
and atmospheric conditions.
A radio station’s signal gets weaker
as you get farther away from its
transmitter. If you are listening to an
AM station, you will notice the sound
volume becoming weaker and the
station drifting in and out. If you are
listening to an FM station, you will
see the stereo indicator flickering off
and on as the signal weakens.
Eventually, the stereo indicator will
go off and the sound will fade
completely as you get out of range of
the station’s signal.

120

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Driving very near the transmitter of
a station that is broadcasting on a
frequency close to the frequency of
the station you are listening to can
also affect your radio’s reception.
You may temporarily hear both
stations, or hear only the station you
are close to.

05/06/03

09:40:52

31SDA630

0124

Playing the Radio
As required by the FCC:
Changes or modifications not expressly
approved by the party responsible for
compliance could void the user’s
authority to operate the equipment.

Features

Radio signals, especially on the FM
band, are deflected by large objects
such as buildings and hills. Your
radio then receives both the direct
signal from the station’s transmitter,
and the deflected signal. This causes
the sound to distort or flutter. This is
a main cause of poor radio reception
in city driving.

Radio reception can be affected by
atmospheric conditions such as
thunderstorms, high humidity, and
even sunspots. You may be able to
receive a distant radio station one
day and not receive it the next day
because of a change in conditions.
Electrical interference from passing
vehicles and stationary sources can
cause temporary reception problems.

121

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/06/03

09:41:02

31SDA630

0125

Playing a CD
U.S. VP, LX, SE, EX and LX-V6
Canadian DX-G, SE and SE-V6

Canadian EX-L and EX-V6 with Navigation System
SCAN/RPT BUTTON

CD
BUTTON

PRESET
BAR

CD SLOT
EJECT BUTTON

SEEK/SKIP
BAR

PRESET BAR

RPT BUTTON
RDM
BUTTON
EJECT
BUTTON
CD SLOT

LOAD
BUTTON
SCAN BUTTON

AUDIO
DISPLAY
BUTTON

SCAN
BUTTON

PWR/VOL KNOB

Canadian EX-L and EX-V6 without Navigation System

SEEK/SKIP
BAR

CD BUTTON

CD LOAD
INDICATOR

SEEK/SKIP
BAR

CD BUTTON

UPPER DISPLAY

RDM
BUTTON

PWR/VOL
KNOB
CD SLOT
LOAD
BUTTON

CD LOAD INDICATOR
PWR/VOL KNOB

122

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

CHANGE
DISC
BUTTON
TRACK
RPT
ICON

DISC
RPT
ICON

CD LOAD INDICATOR

RANDOM
ICON
EJECT BUTTON

05/06/03

09:41:09

31SDA630

0126

Playing a CD
U.S. EX-L and EX-V6 without Navigation System

U.S. EX-L and EX-V6 with Navigation System
UPPER DISPLAY

CD BUTTON

RPT BUTTON
CD BUTTON

RDM
BUTTON
EJECT
BUTTON
SEEK/SKIP
BAR

SEEK BAR

PWR/VOL
KNOB

CD SLOT
CD SLOT

LOAD BUTTON
CD LOAD
INDICATOR

CHANGE
DISC
BUTTON

LOAD
BUTTON

RANDOM
ICON

PWR/VOL KNOB
TRACK
RPT
ICON

DISC RPT
ICON

EJECT
BUTTON

CD LOAD INDICATOR

123

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Features

AUDIO
DISPLAY
BUTTON

05/06/03

09:41:17

31SDA630

0127

Playing a CD, CD Changer
To Play a CD
To load or play CDs, the ignition
switch must be in the ACCESSORY
(I) or ON(II) position.
You operate the CD player/CD
changer with the same controls used
for the radio. To select the CD
player/CD changer, press the CD
button. The number of the track
playing is shown in the display. With
the in-dash CD changer, the disc and
track numbers are displayed. The
system will continuously play a CD
until you change modes.

For Vehicles without in-dash CD
changer

Insert a CD into the CD slot. The
drive will pull the CD in the rest of
the way to play it. When the system
reaches the end of the disc, it will
return to the beginning and play the
disc again.
To play the radio when a CD is
playing, press the AM/FM button.
Press the CD button again to switch
back to the CD player.

For Vehicles with Satellite Radio

To listen to satellite radio when a CD
is playing, press the CD/AUX XM
button.
To play the tape when a CD is
playing, insert a tape in the player
(optional). If a tape is in the player,
press the AUX button. Press the CD
button again to switch back to the
CD player. The cassette player is
optional on all U.S. models.
If you turn the system off while a CD
is playing, either with the PWR/VOL
knob or by turning off the ignition,
the disc will stay in the drive. When
you turn the system back on, the CD
will begin playing where it left off.

Do not use discs with adhesive labels.
The label can curl up and cause the
disc to jam in the unit.

124

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/06/03

09:41:25

31SDA630

0128

Playing a CD, CD Changer
For Vehicles with in-dash CD Changer

You can also load a CD into an empty
position while a CD is playing. Select
the empty position (the disc number
indicator is not highlighted) and
press the appropriate preset bar or
touch a disc icon. The current CD
stops playing and starts the loading
sequence. The CD just loaded will
play.
You operate the CD changer with
the same controls used for the radio.
The numbers of the disc and track
playing are shown in the display. On
vehicles with navigation system,
these numbers also appear in the
upper display.

For Vehicles with in-dash CD Changer

To select a different disc, press the
appropriate side of a preset bar
(1−6) or use the Preset 5 (DISC −)
to select the previous disc or Preset
6 (DISC +) to select the next disc in
sequence. On vehicles with
navigation system, touch the
appropriate disc icon or press the ▲
or ▼ side of the CH/DISC bar. If
you select an empty position in the
CD changer, the system will try to
load the CD in the next available slot.

125

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Features

1. Press the LOAD button until you
hear a beep and see ‘‘LOAd’’ in the
display.
2. The disc number for an empty
position is highlighted and the red
light starts blinking.
3. Insert the disc into the CD slot
when the green CD load indicator
comes on. Insert it only about
halfway; the drive will pull it in the
rest of the way. You will see
‘‘BUSY’’ in the display as the CD
load indicator turns red and blinks
as the CD is loaded.
4. When the CD load indicator turns
green and ‘‘LOAD’’ appears in the
screen again, insert the next CD in
the slot.
5. Repeat steps 1 through 3 until all
six positions are loaded. If you are
not loading all six positions, the
system begins playing the last CD
loaded.

05/06/03

09:41:34

31SDA630

0129

Playing a CD, CD Changer
For Vehicles without Navigation System

to
SEEK/SKIP − Push the
play the next track on the disc. Push
the
once to replay the track in
play; press it twice to replay the
previous track. To move rapidly
within a track, press and hold the
or
button.
REPEAT − Press to continuously
replay a track. You will see RPT in
the display. Press the RPT button
again to turn it off.

RANDOM − Press to play the
tracks in random order. You will see
RDM in the display. Press the RDM
button again to return to normal play.
SCAN − The SCAN function
samples all the tracks on the
selected disc in the order they are
recorded. To activate it, press and
release the SCAN button. You will
see SCAN in the display, and you will
get a 10 second sampling of each
track on the selected CD. Press the
SCAN button again to get out of scan
mode.

EX-L and EX-V6 with Navigation System

To use the controls, press the
AUDIO DISPLAY button, the control
icons will appear on the screen.
TRACK SCAN − Press the icon or
SCAN button, to get a 10 second
sampling of each track on the
current CD. Press the icon or button
again to turn it off.
DISC SCAN − Touch to get a 10
second sampling of the first song of
each disc in the CD changer. Touch
the icon again to turn it off.
TRACK RPT − Touch to
continuously play the same song on
the CD. Press the icon again to stop
the function.

126

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/06/03

09:41:42

31SDA630

0130

Playing a CD, CD Changer
DISC RPT − Touch the icon to
continuously replay the current CD.
Touch again to turn it off.
TRACK RDM − Touch the icon to
play the current CD in random order.
Touch again to stop.

To Stop Playing a CD
For Vehicles with CD Player or
Changer

Press the eject button (
) to
remove the CD. If you eject the CD,
but do not remove it from the slot,
the system will automatically reload
the CD after 15 seconds and put it in
pause mode. To begin playing, press
the CD button.

Removing CDs from the Changer
U.S. EX-L and EX-V6
Canadian EX-L, SE-V6 and EX-V6

If a tape is in the optional tape player,
press the AUX button to switch to
the tape while a CD is playing. Press
the CD button again to switch back
to the CD player.
If you turn the system off while a CD
is playing, the CD will stay in the
drive. When you turn the system
back on, the CD will begin playing
where it left off.

To remove the disc currently playing,
press the EJECT button. When a
disc is removed from a slot, the
system automatically begins the load
sequence so you can load another
CD in that position. If you do not
remove the disc from the changer
within 15 seconds, the system
returns to the previous mode (AM/
FM or satellite radio). The disc will
reload into the system and will
remain there in a pause mode.
To remove a different disc from the
changer, first select it with the
appropriate preset bar or icon. When
that CD begins playing, press the
eject button. Continue pressing the
EJECT button to remove all the discs
from the changer.

127

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Features

CH DISC − Selects an icon and
plays the disc.

U.S. EX-L and EX-V6

Press the AM/FM or XM/CD
button to switch to the radio or
satellite radio while a CD is playing.
Press the CD button again to play
the CD.

05/06/03

09:41:48

31SDA630

0131

Playing a CD, CD Changer
Operating the Optional CD
Changer
U.S. VP and LX
Canadian DX-G and SE

An optional six or eight disc CD
changer is available for your vehicle
from your dealer.
This disc changer uses the same
controls used for the in-dash CD
player/changer or the radio.

Load the desired CDs in the
magazine, and load the magazine in
the changer according to the
instructions that came with the unit.
To select the CD changer, press the
CD button. The disc and track
numbers will be displayed. To select
a different disc, use Preset 5 (DISC
−), for a previous disc; or Preset 6
(DISC +), to select the next disc in
sequence.
If you select an empty slot in the
magazine, the changer will search
for the next available CD to load and
play.

128

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

On LX model, if there are no CDs in
the changer, the display will flash,
and you will have to select another
mode.

05/06/03

09:41:54

31SDA630

0132

CD Player Error Messages
If you see an error message in the
display while playing a CD, find the
cause in the chart to the right. If you
cannot clear the error message, take
the vehicle to your dealer.

Error Message

Cause
FOCUS Error

No CD in the CD
Changer
High Temperature

Press the CD eject button and pull out the CDs.
Check for an error indication. Insert the CDs
again. If the code does not disappear or the
CDs cannot be pulled out, consult your dealer.
Press the CD eject button and pull out the CDs.
Check for an error indication. Insert the CDs
again. If the code does not disappear or the
CDs cannot be pulled out, consult your dealer.
Insert CDs.
Will disappear when the temperature returns to
normal.

129

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Features

Mechanical Error

Solution

05/06/03

09:42:04

31SDA630

0133

Protecting Your CDs
General Information
When using CD-R discs, use only
high quality CDs labeled for audio
use.
When recording a CD-R, the
recording must be closed for it to
be used by the system.
CD-RW discs will not work in this
unit.
Play only standard round CDs.
Odd-shaped CDs may jam in the
drive or cause other problems.
Handle your CDs properly to
prevent damage and skipping. See
this page.

Protecting CDs
When a CD is not being played, store
it in its case to protect it from dust
and other contamination. To prevent
warpage, keep CDs out of direct
sunlight and extreme heat.
To clean a CD, use a clean soft cloth.
Wipe across the CD from the center
to the outside edge.
A new CD may be rough on the
inner and outer edges. The small
plastic pieces causing this roughness
can flake off and fall on the recording surface of the CD, causing
skipping or other problems. Remove
these pieces by rubbing the inner
and outer edges with the side of a
pencil or pen.
Never try to insert foreign objects in
the CD player or the magazine.

130

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Handle a CD by its edges; never
touch either surface. Do not place
stabilizer rings or labels on the CD.
These, along with contamination
from fingerprints, liquids, and felt-tip
pens, can cause the CD to not play
properly, or possibly jam in the drive.

05/06/03

09:42:12

31SDA630

0134

Playing a Tape (U.S. Vehicles)
US. VP, LX, SE, EX and LX-V6
TAPE DIRECTION INDICATOR
RPT INDICATOR
RPT
BUTTON
CD/AUX
BUTTON

U.S. EX-L and EX-V6 with Navigation System
RPT INDICATOR

TAPE DIRECTION INDICATOR

CD/SAT RADIO
BUTTON

UPPER
DISPLAY

PRESET BARS

PWR/VOL KNOB

U.S. EX-L and EX-V6 without Navigation System
RPT INDICATOR
CD/AUX
BUTTON

CH/DISC
BAR

TAPE DIRECTION
INDICATOR
RPT
BUTTON

SEEKBAR
TUNE/
SOUND
KNOB

PWR/VOL
KNOB
SEEK BAR
PROG ICON
PRESET BARS

RPT ICON

NR ICON

PWR/VOL KNOB

131

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Features

AUDIO
DISPLAY
BUTTON

SEEK/SKIP
BAR

05/06/03

09:42:19

31SDA630

0135

Playing a Tape (U.S. Vehicles)
To Play a Tape
Optional on all U.S. models

The ignition switch must be in
ACCESSORY (I) or ON (II). Make
sure the open side of the tape is
facing right, then insert the tape
most of the way into the slot. The
system will pull the tape in the rest
of the way, and begin to play it.
The tape direction indicator will light
to show you which side of the tape is
playing. The ▲ indicates the side
you inserted upward in now playing.
If you want to play the other side,
press the Preset 3 (PLAY/PROG)
side of the preset bar or press the
AUDIO DISPLAY button and touch
the PROG icon. When the player
reaches the end of the tape, it will
automatically reverse direction and
play the other side.

Dolby* noise reduction turns on
when you insert a tape. The
indicator will light in the
display. If the tape was not recorded
in Dolby, turn it off by pressing the
Preset 4 (NR) side of the preset bar
or touching the NR icon. Dolby
remains off until you press the
preset bar or the icon again.
*
Dolby noise reduction
manufactured under license from
Dolby laboratories licensing
Corporation. ‘‘Dolby’’ and the
double-D symbol are trademarks
of the Dolby Laboratories
Licensing Corporation.

132

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

To Stop Playing a Tape
To remove the tape, press the
EJECT button on the cassette player.
If you want to turn the player off,
press the PWR/VOL knob or turn
off the ignition. The tape will remain
in the drive.
When you turn the system back on,
the tape player will be in pause mode.
Press the Preset 3 (PLAY/PROG)
side of the preset bar or touch the
PROG icon on vehicles with
navigation system to resume play.
To switch to the radio or CD player
while a tape is playing, press the
AM/FM, or CD/AUX button or CD/
AUX XM button. To change back to
the tape player, push the CD/AUX
button or CD/AUX XM button.

05/06/03

09:42:26

31SDA630

0136

Playing a Tape (U.S. Vehicles)
SKIP − Press the
side to find
the beginning of the current song or
passage. Press the
side to find
the beginning of the next song or
passage. When the system reaches
the beginning of a song or passage, it
begins to play it.
REPEAT − Press the RPT button
or icon to continuously play a song or
passage. You will see RPT displayed.
The track will repeat until you press
the RPT button or icon again.

For Vehicles with Navigation System

If you see the error message
‘‘
’’ on the display, press the
tape eject button to remove the tape
from the unit. Make sure the tape is
not damaged. If the tape will not
eject or the error message stays on
after the tape ejects, take your
vehicle to your dealer.

EX-L and EX-V6 with Navigation System

FF/REW − To rewind the tape
push the upper side (▲) of the CH
DISC bar. To fast forward the tape,
push the lower side (▼) of the CH
DISC bar. Press either side of the
PROG icon in the audio display to
take the system out of rewind or fast
forward.

NOTE: The SKIP and REPEAT
functions use silent periods on the
tape to find the end of a song or
passage. These features may not
work if there is almost no gap
between selections, a high noise
level, or a silent period in the middle
of a selection.

133

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Features

Tape Search Functions
FF/REW − To rewind the tape,
push the Preset 1 (REW) side of the
preset bar or the upper side (▲) of
the CH DISC bar. You will see REW
in the display. To fast forward the
tape, push the Preset 2 (FF) side of
the preset bar. You will see FF displayed. Press the Preset 1, 2, or 3
side of the bars or the lower side
(▼) of the CH DISC bar to take the
system out of rewind or fast forward.

05/06/03

09:42:32

31SDA630

0137

Playing a Tape (U.S. Vehicles)
Caring for the Tape and Player
The tape player picks up dirt and
oxides from the tape. This
contamination builds up over time
and causes the sound quality to
degrade. To prevent this, you should
clean the player after every 30 hours
of use.

If you do not clean the tape player
regularly, it may eventually become
impossible to remove the
contamination with a normal
cleaning kit. Your dealer has a
cleaning kit available.
Use 100-minute or shorter tapes.
Tapes longer than that may break or
jam the drive.

If the tape is loose, tighten it by
turning the hub with a pencil or your
finger. If the label is peeling off,
remove it or it could cause the tape
to jam in the player. Never try to
insert a warped or damaged tape in
the player.
Store tapes in their cases to protect
them from dust and moisture. Never
place tapes where they will be
exposed to direct sunlight, high heat,
or high humidity. If a tape is exposed
to extreme heat or cold, let it reach a
moderate temperature before
inserting it into the player.
Never try to insert foreign objects
into the tape player.

134

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/06/03

09:42:41

31SDA630

0138

Playing the XMTM Satellite Radio
Satellite Digital Radio
U.S. EX-L and EX-V6

U.S. EX-L and EX-V6
without Navigation System

Your vehicle is capable of receiving
XMTM Satellite Radio anywhere in the
United States except Hawaii, Alaska,
and Canada.

CATEGORY/CHANNEL
MODE INDICATOR

CATEGORY/CHANNEL
MODE INDICATOR
SAT RADIO
BUTTON

DISP
BUTTON

AUDIO
DISPLAY
BUTTON

SAT RADIO
BUTTON
SCAN
BUTTON

Features

XM is a registered trademark of
XM Satellite Radio, Inc.

U.S. EX-L and EX-V6
with Navigation System

Satellite radio is available in U.S.
models only.
TUNE
BAR

SEEK/
SKIP/
BAR

PRESET
BARS

SCAN
BUTTON

SEEK/
SKIP/
BAR
TUNE
KNOB

PWR/VOL
KNOB
PWR/VOL KNOB

SCAN ICON

PRESET
ICONS

MODE ICON

135

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/06/03

09:42:51

31SDA630

0139

Playing the XMTM Satellite Radio
To Play XMTM Satellite Radio
The ignition must be in the
ACCESSORY (I) or ON (II) position.
Turn the system on:
For Vehicles with Navigation System

Push any of the following: PWR/
VOL knob, the CD/AUX XM, or
AUDIO button.

DISP −

TUNE −

For Vehicles with Navigation System

For Vehicles with Navigation System

Press and release this button to
change the display. The display will
change in the following sequence:
channel name, channel number,
category, artist name, and music title.

Turn the TUNE knob to change
channels. Turn the knob right for
higher numbered channels and left
for lower numbered channels.
Vehicles without Navigation System

Press the TUNE bar to change
channel selections. Press
for
higher numbered channels and
for lower numbered channels.

Vehicles without Navigation System

Push any of the following: PWR/
VOL knob or the CD/AUX XM
button.
Turn the PWR/VOL knob to adjust
the volume.
To Select a Channel
When in the satellite radio mode,
you can use any of three methods to
find channels: TUNE, SEEK/SKIP
(CATEGORY), and SCAN.

136

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/06/03

09:42:59

31SDA630

0140

Playing the XMTM Satellite Radio
SCAN − The scan function samples
all channels for 5 seconds. To
activate the function, push the SCAN
button. Push it again to get out of the
sequence.

For Vehicles with Navigation System

Once your XM channels are preset,
pressing the CH DISC button will
select your preset channels.

Preset − Each preset icon or button
can store one channel in XM1 and
one in XM2.
1. Push the CD/AUX XM button.
(You will see XM1 or XM2.)
2. Use the TUNE, SEEK or SCAN
function to tune the radio to a
desired channel.
3. Pick a preset icon or button and
hold it until you hear a beep.
4. Repeat steps 1 to 3 to store a total
of six stations on XM1 and XM2.

Features

SEEK/SKIP (CATEGORY)− The
seek/skip function selects the
various categories in XM, such as
Jazz/Blues, Rock, Classical, etc.
Push the
to change the
category forward. Push the
to
change the category backward. To
search for channels within a
category, turn the TUNE knob
clockwise or press the TUNE bar
.

CONTINUED

137

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/06/03

09:43:04

31SDA630

0141

Playing the XMTM Satellite Radio
Satellite Radio Signals
Satellite radio receives signals from
two satellites to produce clear, highquality digital reception. It offers
many channels in several categories.
Along with a large selection of
different types of music, satellite
radio also allows you to view channel
and category selections in the audio
display.

Signal may be
blocked by
mountains or
large obstacles
to the south.

The XM satellites are in orbit over
the equator; therefore, objects south
of the vehicle may cause satellite
reception interruptions. To help
compensate for this, ground-based
repeaters are placed in major
metropolitan areas. Satellite signals
are more likely to be blocked by tall
buildings and mountains the farther
north you travel from the equator.

SATELLITE

GROUND
REPEATER

138

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/06/03

09:43:12

31SDA630

0142

Playing the XMTM Satellite Radio
Depending on where you drive, you
may experience reception problems.
Interference can be caused by any of
these conditions:

As required by the FCC:
Changes or modifications not expressly
approved by the party responsible for
compliance could void the user’s
authority to operate the equipment.

There may be other geographic
situations that could affect satellite
radio reception.
CONTINUED

139

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Features

Driving on an east/west road with
a mountain on the south side of
the road.
Driving on the north side of a
large commercial truck on an
east/west road.
Driving in tunnels.
Driving on a road beside a vertical
wall, steep cliff, or hill to the south
of you.
Driving on the lower level of a
multi-tiered road.
Driving on a single lane road
alongside dense trees taller than
50 ft. (15 m) to the south of you.

Receiving Satellite Radio Service
If your XM Radio service has expired
or you purchased your vehicle from
a previous owner, you can listen to a
sampling of the broadcasts available
on XM Satellite Radio. With the
ignition switch in the ACCESSORY
(I) or ON (II) position, push the
PWR/VOL knob to turn on the audio
system and press the CD/AUX XM
button. A variety of music types and
styles will play.

05/06/03

09:43:18

31SDA630

0143

Playing the XMTM Satellite Radio
If you decide to purchase XM
Satellite Radio service, contact XM
Radio at www.xmradio.com, or at
1-800-852-9696. You will need to give
them your radio I.D. number and
your credit card number.
To get your XM Satellite radio ID
number:
Turn the TUNE knob until ‘‘0’’
appears in the display. Your I.D. will
appear in the display.

While awaiting activation, make sure
your vehicle remains in an open area
with good reception. Once your
audio system is activated, ‘‘category’’
or ‘‘CH’’ will appear in the display
and you will be able to listen to XM
Radio broadcasts. XM Radio will
continue to send an activation signal
to your vehicle for at least 12 hours
from activation request. If the
service has not been activated after
36 hours, contact XM Radio.

After you have registered with XM
Radio, keep your audio system in the
SAT Radio mode while you await
activation. This should take about 30
minutes.

140

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/06/03

09:43:25

31SDA630

0144

Steering Wheel Controls
U.S. SE, EX, EX-L, LX-V6 and EX-V6
Canadian EX-L, SE-V6 and EX-V6
MODE BUTTON

The VOL button adjusts the volume
up (▲) or down (▼). Press the top
or bottom of the button, hold it until
the desired volume is reached, then
release it.

VOL BUTTON

CH BUTTON

Three controls for the audio system
are mounted in the steering wheel
hub. These let you control basic
functions without removing your
hand from the wheel.

If you are listening to the radio, use
the CH button to change stations.
Each time you press the top (+) of
the button, the system goes to the
next preset station on the band you
are listening to. Press the bottom
(−) to go back to the previous
station.

If you are playing a tape in the
optional tape player, press the top
(+) of the CH button to advance to
the next selection. Press the bottom
(−) to go back to the previous
selection. The system senses a silent
period, then resumes playing.

141

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Features

The MODE button changes the
mode. Pressing the button
repeatedly selects FM1, FM2, AM,
XM1, XM2, CD, or a tape.

If you are playing a CD, the system
skips to the beginning of the next
track each time you press the top
(+) of the CH button. Press the
bottom (−) to return to the
beginning of the current track. Press
it twice to return to the previous
track. You will see the disc and track
numbers in the display.

05/06/03

09:43:33

31SDA630

0145

Radio Theft Protection
Except U.S. VP and LX
Except Canadian DX-G and SE

Your vehicle’s audio system will
disable itself if it is disconnected
from electrical power for any reason.
To make it work again, you must
enter a specific five-digit code using
the preset bars or the TUNE knob.
Because there are hundreds of
number combinations possible from
the five digits, making the system
work without knowing the exact
code is nearly impossible.
You should have received a card that
lists your audio system code number
and serial number. It is best to store
this card in a safe place at home. In
addition, you should write the audio
system’s serial number in this owner’s
manual.
If you lose the card, you must obtain
the code number from a dealer. To
do this, you will need the system’s
serial number.

If your vehicle’s battery is disconnected or goes dead, the audio
system will disable itself. If this
happens, you will see ‘‘CODE’’ in the
frequency display the next time you
turn on the system. Use the preset
buttons to enter the five-digit code.
The code is on the radio code card
included in your Owner’s Manual kit.
When it is entered correctly, the
radio will start playing.
If your vehicle is equipped with a
navigation system, press and release
the TUNE knob; the number ‘‘0’’
appears on the display.
If ‘‘0’’ is the first digit in your code,
press and release the TUNE knob to
store it.
If ‘‘0’’ is not the first digit in your
code, turn the TUNE knob left or
right until the first digit is displayed.
Press and release the TUNE knob to
store it. Enter the remaining three

142

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

digits the same way.
If you make a mistake entering the
code, do not start over; complete the
five-digit sequence, then enter the
correct code. You have 10 tries to
enter the correct code. If you are
unsuccessful in 10 attempts, you
must then leave the system on for 1
hour before trying again.
If the code card is lost, a dealer can
access your code with your radio’s
serial number. To access the serial
number, turn the radio on. It must
display ‘‘CODE’’, then turn the radio
off. Push the preset 1, preset 6, and
power buttons at the same time, then
quickly release.
You will have to store your favorite
stations on each side of the preset
bars (1 − 6) after the system begins
working. Your original settings were
lost when power was disconnected.

05/06/03

09:43:40

31SDA630

0146

Setting the Clock
For Vehicles without Navigation System

If your vehicle’s battery is
disconnected or goes dead, you will
need to set the clock.

For Vehicles without Navigation System
DIGITAL CLOCK

PRESET BARS

SOUND BUTTON

You can quickly set the time to the
nearest hour. Pressing and holding
the SOUND button, then pressing
the R (Preset 6) side of the bar sets
the clock back to the previous hour.
If the displayed time is after the half
hour, the clock sets the clock
forward to the beginning of the next
hour.

For example:
1:06 would RESET to 1:00.
1:52 would RESET to 2:00.
For Vehicles with Navigation System

Refer to the Navigation System
Owner’s Manual to set up the time.

143

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Features

Press and hold the SOUND button
until you hear a beep. The displayed
time begins to blink. Press on the H
(Preset 4) side of the bar until the
numbers advance to the desired time.
Change the minutes by pressing the
M (Preset 5) side of the bar until the
numbers advance to the desired time.
When you are finished, press the
SOUND button again to set the time.

05/06/03

09:43:47

31SDA630

0147

Security System
U.S. EX, EX-L, LX-V6 and EX-V6
Canadian SE, EX-L, SE-V6 and EX-V6

The security system helps to protect
your vehicle and valuables from theft.
The horn sounds and a combination
of headlights, parking lights, side
marker lights and taillights flashes if
someone attempts to break into your
vehicle or remove the radio. This
alarm continues for two minutes,
then the system resets. To reset an
alarming system before the two
minutes have elapsed, unlock either
front door with the key or the
remote transmitter.
The security system automatically
sets 15 seconds after you lock the
doors, hood, and trunk. For the
system to activate, you must lock the
doors from the outside with the key,
lock tab, door lock switch, or remote
transmitter. The security system
light on the instrument panel starts
blinking immediately to show you
the system is setting itself.

SECURITY SYSTEM INDICATOR

Once the security system is set,
opening any door (without using the
key or the remote transmitter), the
hood, or the trunk will cause it to
sound. It also sounds if the radio is
removed from the dashboard or the
wiring is cut.

144

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

With the system set, you can still
open the trunk with the remote
transmitter without triggering the
alarm. The alarm will sound if the
trunk lock is forced, or the trunk is
opened with the trunk release lever
or the emergency trunk opener.
The security system will not set if
the hood, trunk, or any door is not
fully closed. If the system will not set,
check the Door Monitor on the
instrument panel (see page 60 ), to
see if the doors and trunk are fully
closed. Since it is not part of the
monitor display, manually check the
hood.
Do not attempt to alter this system
or add other devices to it.

05/06/03

09:43:54

31SDA630

0148

Cruise Control

Improper use of the cruise
control can lead to a crash.
Use the cruise control only
when traveling on open
highways in good weather.

Using the Cruise Control
CRUISE CONTROL MASTER BUTTON

3. Press and release the DECEL/
SET button on the steering wheel.
The CRUISE CONTROL light on
the instrument panel comes on to
show the system is now activated.

Features

Cruise control allows you to maintain
a set speed above 25 mph (40 km/h)
without keeping your foot on the
accelerator pedal. It should be used
for cruising on straight, open
highways. It is not recommended for
city driving, winding roads, slippery
roads, heavy rain, or bad weather.

CANCEL
BUTTON

DECEL/SET
BUTTON

RES/ACCEL
BUTTON

1. Push in the Cruise Control Master
Button on the steering wheel. The
CRUISE MAIN light on the
instrument panel comes on.
2. Accelerate to the desired cruising
speed above 25 mph (40 km/h).

145

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/06/03

09:44:03

31SDA630

0149

Cruise Control
The cruise control may not hold the
set speed when you are going up and
down hills. If your speed increases
going down a hill, use the brakes to
slow down. This will cancel the
cruise control. To resume the set
speed, press the RES/ACCEL button.
The CRUISE CONTROL light on the
instrument panel will come back on.
Changing the Set Speed
You can increase the set cruising
speed in any of these ways:
Press and hold the RES/ACCEL
button. When you reach the
desired cruising speed, release the
button.

Push on the accelerator pedal. Accelerate to the desired cruising
speed and press the DECEL/SET
button.
To increase the speed in very
small amounts, tap the RES/
ACCEL button. Each time you do
this, your vehicle will speed up
about 1 mph (1.6 km/h).
You can decrease the set cruising
speed in any of these ways:
Press and hold the DECEL/SET
button. Release the button when
you reach the desired speed.
To slow down in very small
amounts, tap the DECEL/SET
button repeatedly. Each time you
do this, your vehicle will slow
down about 1 mph (1.6 km/h).

146

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Tap the brake or clutch pedal
lightly with your foot. The
CRUISE CONTROL light on the
instrument panel will go out.
When the car slows to the desired
speed, press the DECEL/SET
button.
Even with the cruise control turned
on, you can still use the accelerator
pedal to speed up for passing. After
completing the pass, take your foot
off the accelerator pedal. The vehicle
will return to the set cruising speed.
Resting your foot on the brake or
clutch pedal causes the cruise
control to cancel.

05/06/03

09:44:09

31SDA630

0150

Cruise Control
Canceling Cruise Control
You can cancel cruise control in any
of these ways:
Tap the brake or clutch pedal.

Push the cruise control master
button.

Pressing the Cruise Control Master
Button turns the system off and
erases the previous cruising speed.

Features

Push the CANCEL button on the
steering wheel.

Resuming the Set Speed
When you push the CANCEL button,
or tap the brake or clutch pedal, the
system will remember the
previously-set cruising speed. To
return to that speed, accelerate to
above 25 mph (40 km/h) then press
and release the RES/ACCEL button.
The CRUISE CONTROL indicator
comes on. The vehicle will accelerate
to the same cruising speed as before.

147

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/06/03

09:44:19

31SDA630

0151

HomeLink Universal Transceiver
If equipped

The HomeLink universal
transceiver built into your vehicle
can be programmed to operate up to
three remotely controlled devices
around your home, such as garage
doors, lighting, or home security
systems.
General Information
If you are training HomeLink to
operate a garage door or gate, you
should unplug the motor for that
device during training. Repeatedly
pressing the remote control button
could burn out the motor.
HomeLink stores the code in a
permanent memory. There should
be no need to retrain HomeLink if
your vehicle’s battery goes dead or is
disconnected. If your garage door
opener was manufactured before
April 1982, you may not be able to
program HomeLink to operate it.
They do not have the safety feature

that causes the motor to stop and
reverse if an obstacle is detected
during closing, increasing the risk of
injury.
Important Safety Precautions
Always refer to the opening
instructions and safety information
that came with your garage door
opener or other equipment you
intend to operate with HomeLink. If
you do not have this information,
contact the manufacturer of the
equipment.
For quick and accurate training,
make sure the remote control
transmitter for the device (garage
door, automatic gate, security
system, etc.) has a fresh battery.

Training HomeLink
Before you begin − If you just
received your vehicle and have not
trained any of the buttons in
HomeLink before, you should erase
any previously learned codes before
training the first button.
To do this, press and hold the two
outside buttons on the HomeLink
transceiver for about 20 seconds,
until the red indicator flashes.
Release the buttons, then proceed to
step 1.
If you are training the second or
third buttons, go directly to step 1.
1. Unplug the garage door opener
motor from the electrical outlet.
2. Hold the end of the garage door
opener remote 2 to 5 inches from
HomeLink. Make sure you are not
blocking your view of the red
indicator in HomeLink.

148

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/06/03

09:44:30

31SDA630

0152

HomeLink Universal Transceiver
If the red indicator in HomeLink
continues to flash slowly (does
not flash rapidly), your remote
transmitter may stop
transmitting after a short time.
Go to step 4.

5. Plug in the garage door opener
motor, then test the HomeLink
button by pushing it for about 1

6. Push and hold the HomeLink
button for a few seconds, then
watch the red indicator on
HomeLink.
If the indicator stays on or
flashes slowly, repeat steps 2
thru 5.
If the indicator flashes rapidly
for 2 seconds then stays on, you
have a rolling code transmitter:
Go to ‘‘Training with a Rolling
Code System’’ (see page 150 ).
7. Repeat these steps to train the
other two HomeLink buttons to
operate any other compatible
remotely controlled devices
around your home (lighting,
automatic gate, security system,
etc.).

149

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Features

3. Press and hold the remote
transmitter button and one of the
HomeLink buttons at the same
time.
If the red indicator in HomeLink
begins to flash slowly at first,
then rapidly, release both
buttons, and go to step 5.

4. Press and hold the remote
transmitter button and one of the
HomeLink buttons at the same
time. While continuing to hold the
HomeLink button, press and
release the remote transmitter
button every 2 seconds.
If the red indicator in HomeLink
begins to flash slowly at first,
then rapidly, release both
buttons, and go to step 5.
If the red indicator in HomeLink
continues to flash slowly (does
not begin to flash rapidly),
repeat steps 2 thru 4.

second.
If the button works,
programming is complete.
If the button does not work go
to step 6.

05/06/03

09:44:38

31SDA630

0153

HomeLink Universal Transceiver
Training With a Rolling Code
System
For security purposes, newer garage
door opening systems use a ‘‘rolling’’
or variable code. Information from
the remote control and the garage
door opener are needed before
HomeLink can operate the garage
door opener.
The ‘‘Training HomeLink’’
procedure trains HomeLink to the
proper garage door opener code.
The following procedure
synchronizes HomeLink to the
garage door opener so it sends and
receives the correct codes.
1. Make sure you have properly
completed the ‘‘Training
HomeLink’’ procedure.

TRAINING BUTTON

4. Press and hold the button on
HomeLink for 3 to 4 seconds.
5. Press and hold the HomeLink
button again for 3 to 4 seconds.
This should turn off the training
indicator on the garage door
opener unit. (Some systems may
require you to press the button up
to three times.)
6. Press the HomeLink button again.
It should operate the garage door.

3. Press the training button on the
garage door opener unit until the
indicator next to the button comes
on. The indicator may blink, or
come on and stay on. You then
have approximately 30 seconds to
complete the following steps.

2. Find the ‘‘training’’ button on your
garage door opener unit. The
location will vary, depending on
the manufacturer.

150

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/06/03

09:44:49

31SDA630

0154

HomeLink Universal Transceiver
Erasing Codes
To erase the codes stored in all three
buttons, press and hold the two
outside buttons until the red
indicator begins to flash, then
release the buttons.

Retraining a Button
If you want to retrain a programmed
button for a new device, you do not
have to erase all button memory.
You can replace the existing memory
code using this procedure:
1. Press and hold the HomeLink
button to be trained until the
HomeLink indicator begins to
flash slowly.
If a rolling code transmitter was
previously programmed, the
indicator will flash rapidly for 2
seconds, and then stay on for
about 23 seconds.

2. Once the HomeLink indicator
begins to flash slowly, continue to
hold the HomeLink button, and
follow steps 3 thru 6 under
‘‘Training HomeLink’’ (see page
148 ).
Customer Assistance
If you have problems with training
the HomeLink Universal Transceiver,
or would like information on home
products that can be operated by
HomeLink, call (800) 355-3515. On
the Internet, go to
www.homelink.com.
HomeLink is a registered
trademark of Johnson Controls, Inc.

As required by the FCC:
This device complies with Part 15 of the
FCC rules. Operation is subject to the
following two conditions: (1) This device
may not cause harmful interference, and
(2) this device must accept any
interference received, including
interference that may cause undesired
operation.
Changes or modifications not expressly
approved by the party responsible for
compliance could void the user’s
authority to operate the equipment.
This device complies with Industry
Canada Standard RSS-210.
Operation is subject to the following two
conditions: (1) this device may not cause
interference, and (2) this device must
accept any interference that may cause
undesired operation of the device.

151

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Features

You should erase all three codes
before selling the vehicle.

If a standard transmitter was
programmed, the indicator will
stay on for about 25 seconds.

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/06/03

09:44:55

31SDA630

0156

Before Driving
Break-in Period .............................. 154
Fuel Recommendation .................. 154
Service Station Procedures .......... 156
Refueling..................................... 156
Opening and Closing the
Hood ........................................ 157
Oil Check .................................... 159
Engine Coolant Check .............. 160
Fuel Economy ................................ 161
Improving Fuel Economy ......... 161
Accessories and Modifications .... 162
Accessories................................. 162
Modifying Your Vehicle............ 163
Additional Safety Precautions .. 163
Carrying Cargo .............................. 164
Load Limits................................. 165
Carrying Cargo in the Trunk
or on a Roof Rack .................. 166
Carrying Items in the
Passenger Compartment ...... 166

153

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Before Driving

Before you begin driving your
vehicle, you should know what
gasoline to use and how to check the
levels of important fluids. You also
need to know how to properly store
luggage or packages. The
information in this section will help
you. If you plan to add any
accessories to your vehicle, please
read the information in this section
first.

05/06/03

09:45:05

31SDA630

0157

Break-in Period, Fuel Recommendation
Break-in Period
Help assure your vehicle’s future
reliability and performance by paying
extra attention to how you drive
during the first 600 miles (1,000 km).
During this period:
Avoid full-throttle starts and rapid
acceleration.
Do not change the oil until the
scheduled maintenance time.
Avoid hard braking for the first
200 miles (300 km).

Fuel Recommendation
Your vehicle is designed to operate
on unleaded gasoline with a pump
octane number of 87 or higher. Use
of a lower octane gasoline can cause
a persistent, heavy, metallic rapping
noise that can lead to engine damage.
For vehicles with manual transmission

You may hear a knocking noise from
the engine if you drive the vehicle at
low engine speed (below about 1,000
rpm) in a higher gear. To stop this,
raise the engine speed by shifting to
a lower gear.

Do not tow a trailer.
You should also follow these
recommendations with an
overhauled or exchanged engine, or
when the brakes are replaced.

154

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

We recommend quality gasoline
containing detergent additives that
help prevent fuel system and engine
deposits.
In addition, in order to maintain good
performance, fuel economy, and
emissions control, we strongly
recommend, in areas where it is
available, the use of gasoline that
does NOT contain manganese-based
fuel additives such as MMT.

05/06/03

09:45:09

31SDA630

0158

Fuel Recommendation
Some gasoline today is blended with
oxygenates such as ethanol or
MTBE. Your vehicle is designed to
operate on oxygenated gasoline
containing up to 10 percent ethanol
by volume and up to 15 percent
MTBE by volume. Do not use
gasoline containing methanol.

If you notice any undesirable
operating symptoms, try another
service station or switch to another
brand of gasoline.

For further important fuel-related
information, please refer to your
Quick Start Guide.

Before Driving

155

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/06/03

09:45:17

31SDA630

0159

Service Station Procedure
Refueling

Push

Gasoline is highly flammable
and explosive. You can be
burned or seriously injured
when handling fuel.
Stop the engine, and keep
heat, sparks, and flame away.
Handle fuel only outdoors.
Wipe up spills immediately.

1. Park with the driver’s side closest
to the gas pump.

3. Remove the fuel fill cap slowly.
You may hear a hissing sound as
pressure inside the tank escapes.
The fuel fill cap is attached to the
fuel filler with a tether. Put the
attachment on the fuel fill cap into
the slit on the fuel fill door.
4. Stop filling the tank after the fuel
nozzle automatically clicks off. Do
not try to ‘‘top off’’ the tank. Leave
some room for the fuel to expand
with temperature changes.
If the fuel nozzle keeps clicking off

2. To open the fuel fill door, push
down on the lever located to the
left of the driver’s seat.
TETHER
FUEL FILL CAP

156

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

even though the tank is not full,
there may be a problem with your
vehicle’s fuel vapor recovery
system. The system helps keep
fuel vapors from going into the
atmosphere. Try filling at another
pump. If this does not fix the
problem, consult your dealer.

05/06/07

17:18:58

31SDA630

0160

Service Station Procedure
5. Screw the fuel fill cap back on
until it clicks at least once. If you
do not properly tighten the cap,
the malfunction indicator lamp
may come on (see page 251 ). You
will also see a ‘‘CHECK FUEL
CAP’’ message on the odometer/
outside temperature display.

Opening and Closing the Hood
HOOD RELEASE HANDLE

LATCH

To Open the Hood:
1. Park the vehicle, and set the
parking brake. Pull the hood
release handle located under the
lower left corner of the dashboard.
The hood will pop up slightly.

2. Put your fingers under the front
edge of the hood near the center.
Slide your hand to the left until
you feel the hood latch handle.
Push this handle up to release it.
Lift up the hood.
If the hood latch handle moves stiffly,
or if you can open the hood without
lifting the handle, the mechanism
should be cleaned and lubricated.

157

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Before Driving

6. Push the fuel fill door closed until
it latches.

05/06/03

09:45:33

31SDA630

0161

Service Station Procedure
To Close the Hood:
4-cylinder models

Lift it up slightly to remove the
support rod from the hole. Put the
support rod back into its holding clip.
Lower the hood to about a foot (30
cm) above the fender, then let it
drop. Make sure it is securely
latched.

SUPPORT ROD

6-cylinder models
4-cylinder models

3. 4-cylinder models
Pull the support rod out of its clip
and insert the end into the hole on
the front of the hood near the
center.

6-cylinder models

6-cylinder models

Lift the hood up most of the way.
The hydraulic supports will lift it
up the rest of the way and hold it
up.

158

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Lower it to about a foot (30 cm)
above the fender, then press down
firmly with your hands. Make sure it
is securely latched.

05/07/01

10:06:01

31SDA630

0162

Service Station Procedure
Oil Check

4-cylinder models

DIPSTICK
(orange handle)

6-cylinder models

DIPSTICK
(orange loop)

Wait a few minutes after turning the
engine off before you check the oil.

2. Wipe the dipstick with a clean
cloth or paper towel.

1. Remove the dipstick (orange
handle).

3. Insert it all the way back in its hole.

4-cylinder models

4. Remove the dipstick again, and
check the level. It should be
between the upper and lower
marks.
If it is near or below the lower mark,
see Adding Oil on page 204 .

159

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Before Driving

UPPER MARK
LOWER MARK

05/07/01

10:06:10

31SDA630

0163

Service Station Procedure
Engine Coolant Check
RESERVE TANK

MAX

RESERVE TANK

MAX
UPPER MARK
LOWER MARK
6-cylinder models

MIN
4-cylinder models

Look at the coolant level in the
radiator reserve tank. Make sure it is
between the MAX and MIN lines. If
it is below the MIN line, see Adding
Engine Coolant on page 209 for
information on adding the proper
coolant.

160

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

6-cylinder models

MIN

Refer to Owner’s Maintenance
Checks on page 198 for information
about checking other items on your
vehicle.

05/07/01

10:06:19

31SDA630

0164

Fuel Economy
Improving Fuel Economy
Always maintain your vehicle
according to the maintenance
minder. See Owner’s
Maintenance Checks (see page
198 ).

The build-up of snow or mud on
your vehicle’s underside adds
weight and rolling resistance.
Frequent cleaning helps your fuel
mileage and reduces the chance of
corrosion.

Try to maintain a constant speed.
Every time you slow down and
speed up, your vehicle uses extra
fuel. Use cruise control when
appropriate.
Combine several short trips into
one.

Before Driving

For example, an underinflated tire
causes more ‘‘rolling resistance,’’
which uses more fuel.

Always drive in the highest gear
possible.

The air conditioning puts an extra
load on the engine which makes it
use more fuel. Use the fresh-air
ventilation when possible.

Drive moderately. Rapid
acceleration, abrupt cornering,
and hard braking use more fuel.

161

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/06/03

09:46:04

31SDA630

0165

Accessories and Modifications
Modifying your vehicle, or installing
some non-Honda accessories, can
make your vehicle unsafe. Before
you make any modifications or add
any accessories, be sure to read the
following information.
Accessories
Your dealer has Honda accessories
that allow you to personalize your
vehicle. These accessories have
been designed and approved for your
vehicle, and are covered by warranty.
Although non-Honda accessories
may fit on your vehicle, they may not
meet factory specifications, and
could adversely affect your vehicle’s
handling and stability (see next page
for additional information).

Before installing any accessory:
Improper accessories or
modifications can affect your
vehicle’s handling, stability, and
performance, and cause a
crash in which you can be hurt
or killed.
Follow all instructions in this
owner’s manual regarding
accessories and modifications.
When properly installed, cellular
phones, alarms, two-way radios, and
low-powered audio systems should
not interfere with your vehicle’s
computer controlled systems, such
as your airbags and anti-lock brakes.

162

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Make sure the accessory does not
obscure any lights, or interfere
with proper vehicle operation or
performance.
Be sure electronic accessories do
not overload electrical circuits
(see page 257 ) or interfere with
proper operation.
Before installing any electronic
accessory, have the installer
contact your dealer for assistance.
If possible, have your dealer
inspect the final installation.
Do not install accessories on the
side pillars or across the rear
windows. In these areas,
accessories may interfere with
proper operation of the side
curtain airbags.

05/06/03

09:46:13

31SDA630

0166

Accessories and Modifications
Modifying Your Vehicle
Removing parts from your vehicle,
or replacing components with
aftermarket components could
seriously affect your vehicle’s
handling, stability, and reliability.

Raising your vehicle with an
aftermarket suspension kit can
affect the handling and stability.
Non-Honda wheels, because they
are a universal design, can cause
excessive stress on suspension
components.

Modifying your steering wheel or
any other part of your vehicle’s
safety features can make the
systems ineffective.
If you plan to modify your vehicle,
consult your dealer.

Do not attach hard objects on or
near a front door. If a side airbag

or a side curtain airbag inflates, a
cup holder or other hard object
attached on or near the door could
be propelled inside the vehicle and
hurt someone.
Do not place any objects over or
replace the outside edge of a front
seat-back. This could prevent the

airbag from inflating properly.

Additional Safety Precautions
Do not attach or place objects on
the front airbag covers. Any object

attached to or placed on the covers
marked ‘‘SRS AIRBAG’’ in the
center of the steering wheel and
on top of the dashboard, could
interfere with the proper operation
of the airbags. Or, if the airbags
inflate, the objects could be
propelled inside the vehicle and
hurt someone.

163

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Before Driving

Some examples are:
Lowering the vehicle with an
aftermarket suspension kit that
significantly reduces ground
clearance can allow the
undercarriage to hit speed bumps
or other raised objects, which
could cause the airbags to deploy.

Larger or smaller wheels and tires
can interfere with the operation of
your vehicle’s anti-lock brakes and
other systems.

05/06/03

09:46:21

31SDA630

0167

Carrying Cargo

CONSOLE COMPARTMENT
CENTER POCKET

DOOR POCKET

Your vehicle has several convenient
storage areas:
Glove box
Door and seat-back pockets
Trunk, including the back seats
when folded down
Center pocket
Console compartment
Roof-rack (if installed)

GLOVE BOX

TRUNK

SEAT-BACK POCKETS

164

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

However, carrying too much cargo,
or improperly storing it, can affect
your vehicle’s handling, stability,
stopping distance, and tires, and
make it unsafe. Before carrying any
type of cargo, be sure to read the
following pages.

05/06/03

09:46:30

31SDA630

0168

Carrying Cargo
Load Limits
The maximum load for your vehicle
is 850 lbs (395 kg). This figure
includes the total weight of all
occupants, cargo, and accessories,
and the tongue load if you are towing
a trailer.

Follow all load limits and other
loading guidelines in this
manual.

1. Locate the statement, ‘‘the
combined weight of occupants and
cargo should never exceed 850
lbs’’ on your vehicle’s placard.
[The placard is on the driver’s
doorjamb.]
2. Determine the combined weight
of the driver and passengers that
will be riding in your vehicle.
3. Subtract the combined weight of
the driver and passengers from
850 pounds or 395 kilograms.
4. The resulting figure equals the
available amount of cargo and
luggage load capacity.
For example, if the maximum load
is 850 lbs and there will be five 150
lb passengers in your vehicle, the
amount of available cargo and
luggage load capacity is 100 lbs.

(850 − 750 (5 × 150) = 100 lbs.)
5. Determine the combined weight
of luggage and cargo being loaded
on the vehicle. That weight may
not safely exceed the available
cargo and luggage load capacity in
step 4.
6. If your vehicle will be towing a
trailer, the load from your trailer
will be transferred to your vehicle.
Consult this manual to determine
how this reduces the available
cargo and luggage load capacity of
your vehicle (see page 184 ).

CONTINUED

165

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Before Driving

Overloading or improper
loading can affect handling and
stability and cause a crash in
which you can be hurt or killed.

Steps for determining correct load
limit:

05/06/03

09:46:38

31SDA630

0169

Carrying Cargo
In addition, the total weight of the
vehicle, all passengers and
accessories must not exceed the
Gross Vehicle Weight Rating
(GVWR) or the Gross Axle Weight
Rating (GAWR). Both are on a label
on the driver’s doorjamb.

If you carry large items that
prevent you from closing the trunk
lid, exhaust gas can enter the
passenger area. To avoid the
possibility of carbon monoxide
poisoning, follow the instructions
on page 52 .

Carrying Cargo in the Trunk or on
a Roof Rack
Distribute cargo evenly on the
floor of the trunk, placing the
heaviest items on the bottom and
as far forward as possible. Tie
down items that could be thrown
about the vehicle during a crash or
sudden stop.

If you carry any items on a roof
rack, be sure the total weight of
the rack and the items does not
exceed 165 lbs (75 kg).
If you use an accessory roof rack,
the roof rack weight limit may be
lower. Refer to the information that
came with your roof rack.

166

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Carrying Items in the Passenger
Compartment
Store or secure all items that could
be thrown around and hurt
someone during a crash.
Be sure items placed on the floor
behind the front seats cannot roll
under the seats and interfere with
the driver’s ability to operate the
pedals, the proper operation of the
seats, or the advanced front
airbags.
Keep the glove box closed while
driving. If it is open, a passenger
could injure their knees during a
crash or sudden stop.

05/06/03

09:46:42

31SDA630

0170

Driving
This section gives you tips on
starting the engine under various
conditions, and how to operate the
manual and automatic transmissions.
It also includes important
information on parking your vehicle,
the braking system, the traction
control system, and facts you need if
you are planning to tow a trailer.

Towing a Trailer ............................ 184

Driving

Preparing to Drive ......................... 168
Starting the Engine........................ 169
Manual Transmission.................... 170
Recommended Shift Points ...... 171
Engine Speed Limiter ............... 172
Reverse Lockout ........................ 172
Automatic Transmission............... 173
Shift Lever Position
Indicators ................................ 173
Shifting ........................................ 173
Engine Speed Limiter ............... 175
Shift Lock Release ..................... 176
Parking ............................................ 178
Parking Tips ............................... 178
Braking System.............................. 179
Brake System Design................ 179
Brake Wear Indicators .............. 179
Anti-lock Brakes (ABS) ................ 180
Activating the Anti-lock
Brakes ..................................... 180
ABS Indicator ............................. 180
Vehicle Stability Assist (VSA)
System..................................... 182
VSA Activation Indicator .......... 182
VSA System Indicator ............... 182
VSA Off Switch .......................... 183

167

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/06/03

09:46:52

31SDA630

0171

Preparing to Drive
You should do the following checks
and adjustments before you drive
your vehicle.
1. Make sure all windows, mirrors,
and outside lights are clean and
unobstructed. Remove frost, snow,
or ice.

6. Check the seat adjustment (see
pages 85 to 87 ).
7. Check the adjustment of the
inside and outside mirrors (see
pages 90 and 91 ).
8. Check the steering wheel
adjustment (see page 73 ).

2. Check that the hood is fully closed.
3. Check that the trunk is fully
closed.
4. Visually check the tires. If a tire
looks low, use a gauge to check its
pressure.

9. Make sure the doors are securely
closed and locked.
10. Fasten your seat belt. Check that
your passengers have fastened
their seat belts (see page 16 ).

5. Check that any items you may be
carrying are stored properly or
fastened down securely.

168

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

11. When you start the engine, check
the gauges and indicators in the
instrument panel (see pages 58 to
66 ).

05/06/03

09:47:00

31SDA630

0172

Starting the Engine
1. Apply the parking brake.
2. In cold weather, turn off all
electrical accessories to reduce
the drain on the battery.
3. Manual Transmission:
Push the clutch pedal down all the
way.
Automatic Transmission:

The immobilizer system protects your
vehicle f rom thef t. If an improperlycoded key (or other device) is used, the
engine’s f uel system is disabled. For
more inf ormation, see page 75 .

6. If the engine fails to start, press
the accelerator pedal all the way
down and hold it there while
starting to clear flooding. Return
to step 5 if the engine does not
start.

The engine is harder to start in cold
weather. Also, the thinner air f ound at
altitudes above 8,000 f eet (2,400
meters) adds to this problem.

5. If the engine does not start within
15 seconds, or starts but stalls
right away, repeat step 4 with the
accelerator pedal pressed halfway
down. If the engine starts, release
pressure on the accelerator pedal
so the engine does not race.

169

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Driving

Make sure the shift lever is in
Park. Press on the brake pedal.

4. Turn the ignition key to the
START (III) position. Do not hold
the key in START (III) for more
than 15 seconds at a time. If the
engine does not start right away,
pause for at least 10 seconds
before trying again.

05/06/03

09:47:07

31SDA630

0173

Manual Transmission
Come to a full stop before you shift
into Reverse. You can damage the
transmission by trying to shift into
Reverse with the vehicle moving.
Push down the clutch pedal, and
pause for a few seconds before
shifting into Reverse, or shift into
one of the forward gears for a
moment. This stops the gears so
they won’t ‘‘grind.’’
5-speed M/T

On all 4-cylinder models with 5-speed
manual transmission
On all 6-cylinder models with 6-speed
manual transmission

The manual transmission is
synchronized in all forward gears for
smooth operation. It has a lockout so
you cannot shift directly from Fifth
to Reverse.
On vehicles with 6-speed manual
transmission, the lockout system
prevents you from shifting directly

6-speed M/T

from Fifth to Reverse instead of
Sixth (see page 172 ).
When shifting up or down, make
sure you push the clutch pedal down
all the way, shift to the next gear,
and let the pedal up gradually. Avoid
skipping gears when shifting up or
down or serious transmission
damage can occur. When you are not
shifting, do not rest your foot on the
clutch pedal. This can cause your
clutch to wear out faster.

170

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

When slowing down, you can get
extra braking from the engine by
shifting to a lower gear. This extra
braking can help you maintain a safe
speed and prevent your brakes from
overheating while going down a
steep hill. Failure to make sure the
engine speed will not go into the
tachometer’s red zone in a lower
gear can cause serious engine
damage.

05/06/03

09:47:13

31SDA630

0174

Manual Transmission

Rapid slowing or speeding-up
can cause loss of control on
slippery surfaces. If you crash,
you can be injured.
Use extra care when driving on
slippery surfaces.

Recommended Shift Points
Drive in the highest gear that lets
the engine run and accelerate
smoothly. This will give you good
fuel economy and effective
emissions control. The following
shift points are recommended:
With 5-speed manual transmission

Normal acceleration

1st to 2nd
2nd to 3rd
3rd to 4th
4th to 5th

15 mph (25 km/h)
25 mph (40 km/h)
40 mph (65 km/h)
50 mph (80 km/h)

Shift up

Normal acceleration

1st to 2nd
2nd to 3rd
3rd to 4th
4th to 5th
5th to 6th

15 mph (24 km/h)
25 mph (40 km/h)
40 mph (64 km/h)
47 mph (75 km/h)
52 mph (83 km/h)

Driving

Shift up

With 6-speed manual transmission

171

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/06/03

09:47:23

31SDA630

0175

Manual Transmission
Engine Speed Limiter
If you exceed the maximum speed
for the gear you are in, the engine
speed will enter into the tachometer’s
red zone. If this occurs, you may feel
the engine cut in and out. This is
caused by a limiter in the engine’s
computer controls. The engine will
run normally when you reduce the
rpm below the red zone. The Engine
Speed Limiter only limits engine
speed when the accelerator is used.
Attempting to reduce engine speed
by shifting into a lower gear from a
high speed can seriously damage the
engine.

Reverse Lockout
6-speed manual transmission only

The manual transmission has
lockout so you cannot accidentally
shift from Fifth to Reverse instead of
Sixth while the vehicle is moving. If
you cannot shift to Reverse when the
vehicle is stopped:

2. If you are still unable to shift to
Reverse, apply the parking brake,
and turn the ignition key to
ACCESSORY (I) or LOCK (0).
3. Press the clutch pedal, and shift to
Reverse.
4. With the clutch pedal still pressed,
start the engine.
If you need to use this procedure to
shift to Reverse, your vehicle may be
developing a problem. Have the
vehicle checked by your dealer.

Before downshifting, make sure the
engine will not go into the
tachometer’s red zone.
1. With the clutch pedal pressed,
move the shift lever to the first/
second gear side of the Neutral
gate, then shift to Reverse.

172

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/06/03

09:47:30

31SDA630

0176

Automatic Transmission
Shift Lever Position Indicators

If the malfunction indicator lamp
comes on along with the ‘‘D’’
indicator, there is a problem in the
automatic transmission control
system. Avoid rapid acceleration, and
have the transmission checked by
your dealer as soon as possible.

To shift from any position, press the
release button on the bottom of the
shift lever to move it. You cannot
shift out of Park when the ignition
switch is in the LOCK (0) or
ACCESSORY position (I).
To shift from:
P to R

Shifting
SHIFT LEVER

The ‘‘D’’ indicator comes on for a
few seconds when you turn the
ignition switch to the ON (II)
position. If it flashes while driving (in
any shift position), it indicates a
possible problem in the transmission.

Press the release button.

Driving

These indicators between the tachometer and speedometer show which
position the shift lever is in.

R to P
N to R
D3 to 2
2 to 1
1 to 2
2 to D3
D3 to D
D to N
D to D3
N to D
R to N

Do this:
Press the brake pedal and
press the release button.

Move the lever.

173

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/06/03

09:47:37

31SDA630

0177

Automatic Transmission
Park (P) − This position
mechanically locks the transmission.
Use Park whenever you are turning
off or starting the engine. To shift
out of Park, you must press on the
brake pedal and have your foot off
the accelerator pedal. Press the
release button on the bottom of the
shift lever to move it.
If you have done all of the above and
still cannot move the lever out of
Park, see Shift Lock Release on
page 176 .
You must also press the release
button to shift into Park. To avoid
transmission damage, come to a
complete stop before shifting into
Park. The shift lever must be in Park
before you can remove the key from
the ignition switch.

Reverse (R) − Press the brake
pedal and press the release button to
shift from Park to Reverse. To shift
from Reverse to Neutral, come to a
complete stop and then shift.
Neutral (N) − Use Neutral if you
need to restart a stalled engine, or if
it is necessary to stop briefly with
the engine idling. Shift to the Park
position if you need to leave your
vehicle and apply the parking brake.
Press on the brake pedal when you
are moving the shift lever from
Neutral to another gear.
Drive (D) − Use this position for
your normal driving. The
transmission automatically selects a
suitable gear for the vehicle speed
and acceleration. You may notice the
transmission shifting up at higher
speeds when the engine is cold. This
helps the engine warm up faster.

174

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Drive (D3) −This position is similar
to D, except only the first three
gears are selected instead of all five.
Use D3 when towing a trailer in hilly
terrain, or to provide engine braking
when going down a steep hill. D3 can
also keep the transmission from
cycling between third and fourth
gears in stop-and-go driving.

05/06/03

09:47:44

31SDA630

0178

Automatic Transmission
Second (2) − This position locks
the transmission in second gear. It
does not downshift to first gear
when you come to a stop.
Use second gear:
For more power when climbing.

First (1) − To shift from Second to
First, press the release button on the
bottom of the shift lever. This
position locks the transmission in
first gear. By upshifting and
downshifting through 1, 2, D3, and D,
you can operate this transmission
much like a manual transmission
without a clutch pedal.

To increase engine braking when
going down steep hills.

Engine Speed Limiter
If you exceed the maximum speed
for the gear you are in, the engine
speed will enter into the tachometer’s
red zone. If this occurs, you may feel
the engine cut in and out. This is
caused by a limiter in the engine’s
computer controls. The engine will
run normally when you reduce the
rpm below the red zone.
Driving

For starting out on a slippery
surface or in deep snow.
To help reduce wheel spin.
When driving downhill with a
trailer.

175

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/06/03

09:47:51

31SDA630

0179

Automatic Transmission
Shift Lock Release
This allows you to move the shift
lever out of Park if the normal
method of pushing on the brake
pedal and pressing the release
button does not work.

COVER

1. Set the parking brake.
2. Remove the key from the ignition
switch.
3. Put a cloth on the edge of the Shift
Lock Release slot cover next to
the shift lever. Use a small flattipped screwdriver or finger nail
file to remove the cover. Carefully
pry off the edge of the cover.

176

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

4. Insert the key in the Shift Lock
Release slot.

05/06/03

09:47:55

31SDA630

0180

Automatic Transmission
RELEASE
BUTTON

If you need to use the Shift Lock
Release, it means your vehicle is
developing a problem. Have the
vehicle checked by your dealer.

Driving

SHIFT LOCK RELEASE SLOT

5. Push down on the key while you
press the release button on the
shift lever and move the shift lever
out of Park to Neutral.
6. Remove the key from the Shift
Lock Release slot, then reinstall
the cover. Make sure the notch on
the cover is on the left side.
Depress the brake pedal and
restart the engine.

177

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/06/03

09:48:05

31SDA630

0181

Parking
Always use the parking brake when
you park your vehicle. Make sure
the parking brake is set firmly or
your vehicle may roll if it is parked
on an incline.

Parking Tips
Make sure the moonroof (if
equipped) and the windows are
closed.
Turn off the lights.

If your vehicle has an automatic
transmission, set the parking brake
before you put the transmission in
Park. This keeps the vehicle from
moving and putting pressure on the
parking mechanism in the
transmission.
If your vehicle has a manual
transmission, put it in first gear.

Place any packages, valuables, etc.,
in the trunk or take them with you.
Lock the doors with the key or the
remote transmitter.
U.S. EX, EX-L, LX-V6 and EX-V6
Canadian SE, EX-L, SE-V6 and EX-V6

Check the indicator on the
instrument panel to verify that the
security system is set.
Never park over dry leaves, tall
grass, or other flammable
materials. The hot three way
catalytic converter could cause
these materials to catch on fire.

178

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

If the vehicle is facing uphill, turn
the front wheels away from the
curb. If your vehicle has a manual
transmission, put it in first gear.
If the vehicle is facing downhill,
turn the front wheels toward the
curb. If your vehicle has a manual
transmission, put it in reverse gear.
Make sure the parking brake is
fully released before driving away.
Driving with the parking brake
partially set can overheat or
damage the rear brakes.

05/06/03

09:48:12

31SDA630

0182

Braking System
Your vehicle is equipped with disc
brakes. The brakes on the rear
wheels may be disc or drum,
depending on the model. A power
assist helps reduce the effort needed
on the brake pedal. The ABS helps
you retain steering control when
braking very hard.

Check the brakes after driving
through deep water. Apply the
brakes moderately to see if they feel
normal. If not, apply them gently and
frequently until they do. Be extra
cautious in your driving.

Brake Wear Indicators
In all models, the front disc brakes
have audible brake wear indicators.
In all models except the U.S. VP, U.S.
LX and Canadian DX-G, the rear disc
brakes have audible brake wear
indicators.

Constant application of the brakes
when going down a long hill builds
up heat and reduces their effectiveness. Use the engine to assist the
brakes by taking your foot off the
accelerator and downshifting to a
lower gear.

If the brake pads need replacing, you
will hear a distinctive, metallic
screeching sound when you apply
the brake pedal. If you do not have
the brake pads replaced, they will
screech all the time. It is normal for
the brakes to occasionally squeal or
squeak when you apply them.

179

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Driving

Put your foot on the brake pedal only
when you intend to brake. Resting
your foot on the pedal keeps the
brakes applied lightly, builds up heat,
increases wear and reduces their
effectiveness. It also keeps your
brake lights on all the time,
confusing drivers behind you.

Braking System Design
The hydraulic system that operates
the brakes has two separate circuits.
Each circuit works diagonally across
the vehicle (the left-front brake is
connected with the right-rear brake,
etc.). If one circuit should develop a
problem, you will still have braking
at two wheels.

05/06/03

09:48:19

31SDA630

0183

Anti-lock Brakes (ABS)
Anti-lock Brakes (ABS)
The anti-lock brake system (ABS)
helps prevent the brakes from
locking up, and helps you retain
steering control by pumping the
brakes rapidly, much faster than a
person can do it.
The ABS also balances the front-torear braking distribution according
to vehicle loading.

Activating the Anti-lock Brakes
You will feel a pulsation in the brake
pedal when the ABS activates, and
you may hear some noise. This is
normal: it is the ABS rapidly
pumping the brakes. On dry
pavement, you will need to press on
the brake pedal very hard before the
ABS activates. However, you may
feel the ABS activate immediately if
you are trying to stop on snow or ice.

You should never pump the brake pedal;

this defeats the purpose of the ABS.
Let the ABS work for you by always
keeping firm, steady pressure on the
brake pedal as you steer away from
the hazard. This is sometimes
referred to as ‘‘stomp and steer.’’

180

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

ABS Indicator
If this indicator comes on, the antilock function of the braking system
has shut down. The brakes still work
like a conventional system, but
without anti-lock. You should have
your dealer inspect your vehicle as
soon as possible.
If the ABS indicator and the brake
system indicator come on together,
and the parking brake is fully
released, the front-to-rear braking
distribution system may also be shut
down.

05/06/03

09:48:25

31SDA630

0184

Anti-lock Brakes (ABS)
steering control during braking.
ABS INDICATOR

ABS will not prevent a skid that
results from changing direction
abruptly, such as trying to take a
corner too fast or making a sudden
lane change. Always drive at a safe
speed for the road and weather
conditions.

Important Safety Reminders

ABS does not reduce the time or
distance it takes to stop the
vehicle. It only helps with the

Driving

Test your brakes as instructed on
page 253 . If the brakes feel normal,
drive slowly and have your vehicle
repaired by your dealer as soon as
possible. Avoid sudden hard braking
which could cause the rear wheels to
lock up and possibly lead to a loss of
control.

ABS cannot prevent a loss of
stability. Always steer moderately
when you are braking hard. Severe
or sharp steering wheel movement
can still cause your vehicle to veer
into oncoming traffic or off the road.
A vehicle with ABS may require a
longer distance to stop on loose or
uneven surfaces, such as gravel or
snow, than a vehicle without antilock. Slow down, and allow a greater
distance between vehicles under
those conditions.

181

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/06/03

09:48:34

31SDA630

0185

Vehicle Stability Assist (VSA) System

VSA ACTIVATION
INDICATOR

VSA SYSTEM
INDICATOR

The Vehicle Stability Assist system
helps to stabilize the vehicle during
cornering if the vehicle turns more
or less than desired. It also assists
you in maintaining traction while
accelerating on loose or slippery
road surfaces. It does this by
regulating the engine’s output, and
by selectively applying the brakes.

When VSA activates, you may notice
that the engine does not respond to
the accelerator in the same way it
does at other times. There may also
be some unusual noise from the
modulator.
The VSA system cannot enhance the
vehicle’s driving stability in all
situations and does not control your
vehicle’s entire braking system. It is
still your responsibility to drive and
corner at reasonable speeds and to
leave a sufficient margin of safety.

182

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

VSA Activation Indicator
When VSA activates, you will see the
VSA activation indicator blink. There
may also be some unusual noise
from the modulator.
VSA System Indicator
If the VSA system indicator comes
on while driving, pull to the side of
the road when it is safe, and turn off
the engine. Reset the system by
restarting the engine. If the VSA
system indicator stays, or comes
back on while driving, have the VSA
system inspected by your dealer.

05/06/03

09:48:42

31SDA630

0186

Vehicle Stability Assist (VSA) System
If the indicator does not come on
when the ignition switch is turned to
the ON (II) position, there may be a
problem with the VSA system. Have
your dealer inspect your vehicle as
soon as possible.

VSA Off Switch
VSA OFF SWITCH

VSA is turned on every time you
start the engine, even if you turned it
off the last time you drove the
vehicle.

Without VSA, your vehicle will have
normal braking and cornering ability,
but it will not have VSA traction and
stability enhancement.

This switch is under the left vent.
Press it to turn the VSA system on
and off.
When VSA is off, the VSA activation
indicator comes on as a reminder.

Deactivate the VSA system if you
need to drive with the compact spare
tire installed (see page 238 ).
If you install winter tires, make sure
they are the same size as those that
were originally supplied with your
vehicle. Exercise the same caution
during winter driving as you would if
your vehicle was not equipped with
VSA.

183

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Driving

VSA and Tire Sizes
Driving with varying tire or wheel
sizes may cause the VSA to
malfunction. When replacing tires,
make sure they are of the same size
and type as your original tires (see
page 231 ).

05/06/03

09:48:48

31SDA630

0187

Towing a Trailer
Your vehicle has been designed to
primarily carry passengers and their
cargo. You can also use it to tow a
trailer if you carefully observe the
load limits, use the proper equipment,
and follow the guidelines in this
section.

Exceeding any load limit or
improperly loading your vehicle
and trailer can cause a crash in
which you can be seriously hurt
or killed.
Check the loading of your
vehicle and trailer carefully
before starting to drive.

Load Limits

Total Trailer Weight: The
maximum allowable weight of the
trailer and everthing in or on it
must not exceed 1,000 lbs (450 kg).
Towing a load that is too heavy
can seriously affect your vehicle’s
handling and performance. It can
also damage the engine and
drivetrain.

184

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Tongue Load: The weight that
the tongue of a fully-loaded trailer
puts on the hitch should be
approximately 10 percent of the
trailer weight. Too much tongue
load reduces front-tire traction and
steering control. Too little tongue
load can make the trailer unstable
and cause it to sway.

05/06/03

09:48:53

31SDA630

0188

Towing a Trailer
To achieve a proper tongue load,
start by loading 60 percent of the
load toward the front of the trailer
and 40 percent toward the rear, then
re-adjust the load as needed.

Gross Vehicle Weight Rating
(GVWR):
The total weight of the vehicle, all
occupants, all cargo, and the
tongue load must not exceed:
U.S. VP and LX:
Canadian DX-G:

4,080 Ibs (1,850 kg)
U.S. EX-L and SE:
Canadian SE and EX-L:

4,345 Ibs (1,970 kg)
U.S. EX-V6 with manual transmission:
Canadian EX-V6 with manual
transmission:

4,300 Ibs (1,950 kg)

U.S. VP and LX:
Canadian DX-G:

2,195 Ibs (995 kg)
on the front axle
1,960 Ibs (890 kg)
on the rear axle
U.S. EX, EX-L and SE:
Canadian SE and EX-L:

Driving

4,145 Ibs (1,880 kg)
U.S. LX-V6 and EX-V6 with automatic
transmission:
Canadian SE-V6 and EX-V6 with
automatic transmission:

Gross Axle Weight Rating
(GAWR):
The total weight of each axle must
not exceed:

2,225 Ibs (1,010 kg)
on the front axle
1,985 Ibs (900 kg)
on the rear axle
U.S. LX-V6 and EX-V6:
Canadian SE-V6 and EX-V6:

2,360 Ibs (1,070 kg)
on the front axle
2,005 Ibs (910 kg)
on the rear axle

185

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/06/03

09:49:02

31SDA630

0189

Towing a Trailer
Checking Loads
The best way to confirm that vehicle
and trailer weights are within limits
is to have them checked at a public
scale. To locate the public scales in
your area, consult your local yellow
pages or ask your dealer for
assistance.
Using a suitable scale or a special
tongue load gauge, check the tongue
load the first time you set up a
towing combination (a fully-loaded
vehicle and trailer), then recheck the
tongue load whenever the conditions
change.

Towing Equipment and
Accessories
Towing can require a variety of
equipment, depending on the size of
your trailer, how it will be used, how
much load you are towing, and
where you tow. To ensure the best
quality, we recommend that you
purchase Honda equipment
whenever possible.
Discuss your needs with your trailer
sales or rental agency, and follow the
guidelines in the rest of this section.
Also make sure that all equipment is
properly installed and that it meets
federal, state, province, and local
regulations.

186

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Hitches

Any hitch used on your vehicle must
be properly bolted to the underbody.
Safety Chains

Always use safety chains when you
tow a trailer. Make sure the chains
are secured to the trailer and hitch,
and that they cross under the tongue
and can catch the trailer if it
becomes unhitched. Leave enough
slack to allow the trailer to turn
corners easily, but do not let the
chains drag on the ground.

05/06/03

09:49:09

31SDA630

0190

Towing a Trailer
Trailer Brakes

Trailer Lights

Additional Towing Equipment

Honda recommends that any trailer
having a total weight of 1,000 lbs
(450 kg) or more be equipped with
its own electric or surge-type brakes.

Trailer lights and equipment must
comply with federal, state, and
regulations. Check with your local
trailer sales or rental agency for the
requirements in your area, and use
only equipment designed for your
vehicle.

Many states and provinces require
special outside mirrors when towing
a trailer. Even if they don’t, you
should install special mirrors if you
cannot clearly see behind you, or if
the trailer creates a blind spot.

See your trailer dealer for more
information on installing electric
brakes.

Since lighting and wiring vary by
trailer type and brand, you should
have a qualified technician install a
suitable connector between the
vehicle and the trailer. Improper
equipment or installation can cause
damage to your vehicle’s electrical
system and affect your vehicle
warranty.

Ask your trailer sales or rental
agency if any other items are
recommended or required for your
towing situation.

187

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Driving

If you choose electric brakes, be
sure they are electrically actuated.
Do not attempt to tap into your
vehicle’s hydraulic system. No
matter how successful it may seem,
any attempt to attach trailer brakes
to your vehicle’s hydraulic system
will lower braking effectiveness and
create a potential hazard.

05/06/03

09:49:18

31SDA630

0191

Towing a Trailer
Pre-Tow Checklist
When preparing to tow, and before
driving away, be sure to check the
following:

Your vehicle tires and spare are
properly inflated (see page 227 ),
and the trailer tires and spare are
inflated as recommended by the
trailer maker.

The vehicle has been properly
serviced, and the tires, brakes,
suspension, cooling system, and
lights are in good operating
condition.

Driving Safely With a Trailer
The added weight, length, and
height of a trailer will affect your
vehicle’s handling and performance,
so driving with a trailer requires
some special driving skills and
techniques.
For your safety and the safety of
others, take time to practice driving
maneuvers before heading for the
open road, and follow the guidelines
below.

All weights and loads are within
limits (see pages 184 and 186 ).
The hitch, safety chains, and any
other attachments are secure.

Towing Speeds and Gears

Drive slower than normal in all
driving situations, and obey posted
speed limits for vehicles with trailers.
If you have an automatic
transmission, use the D position
when towing a trailer on level roads.

All items in or on the trailer are
properly secured and cannot shift
while you drive.

188

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/06/03

09:49:27

31SDA630

0192

Towing a Trailer
Making Turns and Braking

Make turns more slowly and wider
than normal. The trailer tracks a
smaller arc than your vehicle, and it
can hit or run over something the
vehicle misses. Allow more time and
distance for braking. Do not brake or
turn suddenly as this could cause the
trailer to jackknife or turn over.
Driving on Hills

D3 is the proper shift lever position
to use when towing a trailer in hilly
terrain.

If you must stop when facing uphill,
use the foot brake or parking brake.
Do not try to hold the vehicle in
place by pressing on the accelerator,
as this can cause the automatic
transmission to overheat.
Handling Crosswinds and Buffeting

Crosswinds and air turbulence
caused by passing trucks can disrupt
your steering and cause trailer
swaying. When being passed by a
large vehicle, keep a constant speed
and steer straight ahead. Do not try
to make quick steering or braking
corrections.

Backing Up

Always drive slowly and have
someone guide you when backing up.
Grip the bottom of the steering wheel,
then turn the wheel to the left to get
the trailer to move to the left. Turn
the wheel to the right to move the
trailer to the right.
Parking

Follow all normal precautions when
parking, including firmly setting the
parking brake and putting the
transmission in Park (automatic) or
in 1st or reverse (manual). Also,
place wheel chocks at each of the
trailer’s tires.

189

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Driving

When climbing hills, closely watch
your temperature gauge. If it nears
the red (hot) mark, turn the air
conditioning off, reduce speed and, if
necessary, pull to the side of the
road to let the engine cool.

When driving down hills, reduce
your speed, and shift down to second
gear. Do not ‘‘ride’’ the brakes, and
remember, it will take longer to slow
down and stop when towing a trailer.

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/07/01

10:06:26

31SDA630

0194

Maintenance
This section explains why it is
important to keep your vehicle well
maintained and how to follow basic
maintenance safety precautions.
This section also includes
instructions on how to read the
maintenance messages, a
maintenance record, and instructions
for simple maintenance tasks you
may want to take care of yourself.

Tires ................................................ 227
Inflation Guidelines ................... 227
Recommended Tire
Pressures ................................ 228
Tire Inspection ........................... 229
Tire Maintenance ...................... 229
Tire Rotation .............................. 230
Replacing Tires .......................... 231
Wheels and Tires ....................... 231
Winter Driving ........................... 232
Snow Tires .............................. 232
Tire Chains ............................. 232
Checking the Battery .................... 234
Vehicle Storage .............................. 235

191

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Maintenance

If you have the skills and tools to
perform more complex maintenance
tasks on your vehicle, you may want
to purchase the service manual. See
page 281 for information on how to
obtain a copy, or see your dealer.

Maintenance Safety ....................... 192
Maintenance Minder ..................... 193
Maintenance Record ..................... 200
Fluid Locations............................... 202
Adding Engine Oil ......................... 204
Recommended Engine Oil........ 204
Synthetic Oil ............................... 205
Engine Oil Additives ................. 205
Changing the Oil and Filter .......... 206
Windshield Washers ..................... 208
Engine Coolant ............................... 209
Adding Engine Coolant ............. 209
Transmission Fluid ........................ 211
Automatic
Transmission.......................... 211
Manual
Transmission.......................... 214
Brake and Clutch Fluid ................. 215
Brake Fluid ................................. 216
Clutch Fluid ................................ 216
Power Steering Fluid ..................... 216
Timing Belt ..................................... 217
Lights .............................................. 218
Seat Belts ........................................ 224
Floor Mats ...................................... 224
Wiper Blades .................................. 225

05/06/03

09:49:44

31SDA630

0195

Maintenance Safety
All service items not detailed in this
section should be performed by a
certified technician or other qualified
mechanic.
Important Safety Precautions
To eliminate potential hazards, read
the instructions before you begin,
and make sure you have the tools
and skills required.
Make sure your vehicle is parked
on level ground, the parking brake
is set, and the engine is off.
To clean parts, use a commercially
available degreaser or parts
cleaner, not gasoline.
To reduce the possibility of fire or
explosion, keep cigarettes, sparks,
and flames away from the battery
and all fuel-related parts.
Wear eye protection and
protective clothing when
working near the battery or
when using compressed air.

Improperly maintaining this
vehicle or failing to correct a
problem before driving can
cause a crash in which you can
be seriously hurt or killed.
Always follow the inspection,
maintenance recommendations,
and schedules in this owner’s
manual.
Potential Vehicle Hazards
Carbon Monoxide poison
from engine exhaust. Be sure
there is adequate ventilation
whenever you operate the
engine.
Burns from hot parts. Let the
engine and exhaust system cool
before touching any parts.
Injury from moving parts. Do
not run the engine unless
instructed to do so.

192

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Failure to properly follow
maintenance instructions and
precautions can cause you to
be seriously hurt or killed.
Always follow the procedures
and precautions in this owner’s
manual.
Some of the most important safety
precautions are given here. However,
we cannot warn you of every
conceivable hazard that can arise in
performing maintenance. Only you
can decide whether or not you
should perform a given task.

05/07/01

10:29:46

31SDA630

0196

Maintenance Minder
Your vehicle displays engine oil life
and maintenance service items in the
information display to show you
when you should have your dealer
perform engine oil replacement and
indicated maintenance service.
Based on the engine operating
conditions and accumulated engine
revolutions, the onboard computer in
your vehicle calculates the remaining
engine oil life and displays it as a
percentage.

Engine Oil Life Indicator
SELECT/RESET KNOB

ENGINE OIL LIFE DISPLAY

Calculated Engine
Oil Life (%)
100 % − 91 %
90 % − 81 %
80 % − 71 %
70 % − 61 %
60 % − 51 %
50 % − 41 %
40 % − 31 %
30 % − 21 %
20 % − 16 %
15 % − 11 %
10 % − 6 %
5%−1%
0%

Displayed
Engine Oil Life (%)
100 %
90 %
80 %
70 %
60 %
50 %
40 %
30 %
20 %
15 %
10 %
5%
0%

CONTINUED

193

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Maintenance

To see the current engine oil life,
turn the ignition switch to the ON
(II) position, and push and release
the Select/Reset knob repeatedly
until the engine oil life display
appears (see page 64 ).

The remaining engine oil life is
displayed on the engine oil life
display according to this table:

05/07/01

10:29:53

31SDA630

0197

Maintenance Minder

MAINTENANCE MINDER INDICATOR

The maintenance item code or codes
indicate the main and sub items
required at the time of the oil change
(see page 199 ).

ENGINE OIL LIFE INDICATOR
MAINTENANCE ITEM CODE(S)

When the remaining engine oil life is
5 to 1 percent, you will see a
‘‘SERVICE OIL LIFE’’ message
along with the same maintenance
item code(s), every time you turn the
ignition switch to the ON (II)
position.

If the remaining engine oil life is 15
to 6 percent, you will see the engine
oil life indicator every time you turn
the ignition switch to the ON (II)
position. The maintenance minder
indicator will also come on, and the
maintenance item code(s) for other
scheduled maintenance items
needing service will be displayed
next to the engine oil life indicator.

194

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/07/01

10:30:02

31SDA630

0198

Maintenance Minder
The maximum total mileage shown
is ‘‘−9999.’’
You can change the information
display from the engine oil life
display to the odometer, the trip
meter, or the outside temperature (if
equipped) every time you press and
release the Select/Reset knob.

If you still do not perform the
indicated maintenance, you will see a
negative mileage. It is displayed
when you drive over 10 miles (for
U.S. models) or 10 km (for Canadian
models) after seeing the 0 percent
message. Afterward, it shows your
driving distance if you continue to
drive. Immediately have the
indicated maintenance done by your
dealer.

Immediately have the service
performed, and make sure to reset
the display as described in the next
page.

195

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Maintenance

When the remaining engine oil life is
0 percent, the engine oil life indicator
will be blinking. The display comes
on every time you turn the ignition
switch to the ON (II) position. When
you see this message, have the
indicated maintenance performed by
your dealer as soon as possible.

When the engine oil life display is 0
percent or negative mileage, the
maintenance minder indicator
remains on even if you change the
information display.

05/07/01

10:30:13

31SDA630

0199

Maintenance Minder
Maintenance Main Items and Sub
Items

ENGINE OIL LIFE
INDICATOR
MAINTENANCE ITEM CODE

When the vehicle needs
maintenance, maintenance codes
appear on the information display.
For an explanation of the
maintenance codes, see page 199 .

Resetting the Engine Oil Life
Indicator
Your dealer will reset the display
after completing the required
maintenance service. You will see
‘‘OIL LIFE 100 %’’ on the odometer/
trip meter display the next time you
turn the ignition switch to the ON
(II) position.
If maintenance service is done by
someone other than your dealer,
reset the maintenance minder as
follows:
1. Turn the ignition switch to the ON
(II) position.
2. Press the Select/Reset knob until
the engine oil life indicator is
displayed.

196

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

3. Press the Select/Reset knob for
more than 10 seconds. The engine
oil life indicator and the
maintenance item code(s) will
blink.

05/07/01

10:30:21

31SDA630

0200

Maintenance Minder
Important Maintenance
Precautions
If you have the required service
done but do not reset the display, or
reset the display without doing the
service, the system will not show the
proper maintenance intervals. This
can lead to serious mechanical
problems because you will no longer
have an accurate record of when
maintenance is needed.
Your authorized Honda dealer
knows your vehicle best and can
provide competent, efficient service.

We recommend the use of Honda
parts and fluids whenever you have
maintenance done. These are
manufactured to the same highquality standards as the original
components, so you can be confident
of their performance and durability.

CONTINUED

197

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Maintenance

4. Press the Select/Reset knob for
more than 5 seconds. The
maintenance items code(s) will
disappear, and the engine oil life
will reset to ‘‘100.’’

However, service at a dealer is not
mandatory to keep your warranties
in effect. Maintenance may be done
by any qualified service facility or
person who is skilled in this type of
automotive service. Make sure to
have the service facility or person
reset the display as previously
described. Keep all receipts as proof
of completion, and have the person
who does the work fill out the
maintenance record. Check your
warranty booklet for more
information.

05/07/01

10:30:33

31SDA630

0201

Maintenance Minder
U.S. Vehicles:
Maintenance, replacement, or
repair of emissions control
devices and systems may be done
by any automotive repair
establishment or individual using
parts that are ‘‘certified’’ to EPA
standards.
According to state and federal
regulations, failure to perform
maintenance on the items marked
with # will not void your emissions
warranties. However, all
maintenance services should be
performed in accordance with the
intervals indicated by the odometer/
trip meter display.

Owner’s Maintenance Checks
You should check the following
items at the specified intervals. If
you are unsure of how to perform
any check, turn to the appropriate
page listed.
Engine oil level − Check every
time you fill the fuel tank. See
page 159 .
Engine coolant level − Check the
radiator reserve tank every time
you fill the fuel tank. See page 160 .
Automatic transmission − Check
the fluid level monthly. See page
211 .
Brakes − Check the fluid level
monthly. See page 215 .
Tires − Check the tire pressure
monthly. Examine the tread for
wear and foreign objects. See page
227 .

198

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Lights − Check the operation of
the headlights, parking lights,
taillights, high-mount brake light,
and license plate lights monthly.
See page 218 .

05/07/01

10:30:41

31SDA630

0202

Maintenance Minder
Symbol
A
B

3

If the message ‘‘SERVICE OIL’’ does not appear more than 12 months after
the display is reset, change the engine oil every year.

# : See information on maintenance and emissions warranty in the first column
on page 197 .
NOTE:

Independent of the maintenance minder display, replace the brake fluid
every 3 years.

4

Inspect idle speed every 160,000 miles (256,000 km).
Adjust the valves during services A, B, 1, 2, or 3 if they are noisy.

5

Maintenance Sub Items
Rotate tires
Replace air cleaner element
If you drive in dusty conditions, replace every 15,000
miles (24,000 km).
Replace dust and pollen filter
If you drive primarily in urban areas that have high
concentrations of soot in the air from industry and from
diesel-powered vehicles, replace every 15,000 miles
(24,000 km).
Inspect drive belt
Replace transmission fluid
Driving in mountainous areas at very low vehicle speeds
or trailer towing results in higher transmission and
transfer temperatures. This requires transmission and
transfer fluid changes more frequently than
recommended by the Maintenance Minder. If you
regularly drive your vehicle under these conditions, have
the transmission and transfer fluid changed at 60,000
miles (100,000 km), then every 30,000 miles (48,000 km)
(For A/T only:)
Replace spark plugs
Replace timing belt and inspect water pump
(V6 engine only)
If you drive regularly in very high temperatures (over
110°F, 43°C), or in very low temperatures (under −20°F,
−29°C), replace every 60,000 miles (U.S.)/100,000 km
(Canada).
Inspect valve clearance
Replace engine coolant

199

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Maintenance Minder

*1 :

Symbol
1
2

Maintenance Main Items
Replace engine oil*1
Replace engine oil*1 and oil filter
Inspect front and rear brakes
Check parking brake adjustment
Inspect these items:
Tie rod ends, steering gear box, and boots
Suspension components
Driveshaft boots
Brake hoses and lines (including ABS)
All fluid levels and condition of fluids
Exhaust system#
Fuel lines and connections#

05/07/01

10:30:49

31SDA630

0203

Maintenance Record
You or the servicing dealer can record all completed maintenance here. When maintenance is performed, record the mileage, circle the coded item(s)
completed, and write in any other non-coded items (such as brake fluid replacement) below the codes. Keep the receipts for all work done on your
vehicle.
Mileage

Maintenance
Performed

Signature

Mileage

Maintenance
Performed

Signature

Date

Date

mi
km

A

B

1

2

3

4

5

mi
km

A

B

1

2

3

4

5

mi
km

A

B

1

2

3

4

5

mi
km

A

B

1

2

3

4

5

mi
km

A

B

1

2

3

4

5

mi
km

A

B

1

2

3

4

5

mi
km

A

B

1

2

3

4

5

mi
km

A

B

1

2

3

4

5

mi
km

A

B

1

2

3

4

5

mi
km

A

B

1

2

3

4

5

mi
km

A

B

1

2

3

4

5

mi
km

A

B

1

2

3

4

5

mi
km

A

B

1

2

3

4

5

mi
km

A

B

1

2

3

4

5

200

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/07/01

10:30:56

31SDA630

0204

Maintenance Record
Mileage

Maintenance
Performed

Signature

Mileage

Maintenance
Performed

Signature

Date

Date

A

B

1

2

3

4

5

mi
km

A

B

1

2

3

4

5

mi
km

A

B

1

2

3

4

5

mi
km

A

B

1

2

3

4

5

mi
km

A

B

1

2

3

4

5

mi
km

A

B

1

2

3

4

5

mi
km

A

B

1

2

3

4

5

mi
km

A

B

1

2

3

4

5

mi
km

A

B

1

2

3

4

5

mi
km

A

B

1

2

3

4

5

mi
km

A

B

1

2

3

4

5

mi
km

A

B

1

2

3

4

5

mi
km

A

B

1

2

3

4

5

mi
km

A

B

1

2

3

4

5

Maintenance

mi
km

201

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/07/01

10:31:02

31SDA630

0205

Fluid Locations
4-cylinder Models
BRAKE FLUID
(Gray cap)

CLUTCH FLUID
(5-speed Manual
Transmission only)
(Light gray cap)

ENGINE OIL DIPSTICK
(Orange handle)

ENGINE OIL
FILL CAP

WASHER FLUID
(Blue cap)

AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION
FLUID DIPSTICK
(Yellow loop)

POWER STEERING
FLUID (Red cap)

COOLANT
RESERVOIR

RADIATOR CAP

202

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/07/01

10:31:08

31SDA630

0206

Fluid Locations
6-cylinder Models
ENGINE OIL FILL CAP
CLUTCH FLUID
(6-speed Manual
Transmission only)
(Light gray cap)

ENGINE OIL DIPSTICK
(Orange loop)

Maintenance

AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION
FLUID DIPSTICK
(Yellow loop)
WASHER FLUID
(Blue cap)
COOLANT
RESERVOIR
POWER STEERING
FLUID (Red cap)

RADIATOR CAP

203

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/07/01

10:31:16

31SDA630

0207

Adding Engine Oil
ENGINE OIL FILL CAP

ENGINE OIL FILL CAP

4-cylinder models

6-cylinder models

Unscrew and remove the engine oil
fill cap on top of the valve cover.
Pour in the oil slowly and carefully so
you do not spill any. Clean up any
spills immediately. Spilled oil could
damage components in the engine
compartment.

Install the engine oil fill cap, and
tighten it securely. Wait a few
minutes, and recheck the oil level.
Do not fill above the upper mark; you
could damage the engine.

204

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Recommended Engine Oil
Oil is a major contributor to your
engine’s performance and longevity.
Always use a premium-grade 5W-20
detergent oil displaying the API
Certification Seal. This seal indicates
the oil is energy conserving, and that
it meets the American Petroleum
Institute’s latest requirements.

05/07/01

10:31:26

31SDA630

0208

Adding Engine Oil
Honda Motor Oil is the preferred
5W-20 lubricant for your vehicle. It is
highly recommended that you use
Honda Motor Oil in your vehicle for
optimum engine protection. Make
sure the API Certification Seal says
‘‘For Gasoline Engines.’’

The oil viscosity or weight is
provided on the container’s label.
5W-20 oil is formulated for yearround protection of your vehicle to
improve cold weather starting and
fuel economy.

Synthetic Oil
You may use a synthetic motor oil if
it meets the same requirements
given for a conventional motor oil: it
displays the API Certification Seal,
and it is the proper weight. You must
follow the oil and filter change
intervals shown on the information
display.

Ambient Temperature
API CERTIFICATION SEAL

205

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Maintenance

Engine Oil Additives
Your vehicle does not require any oil
additives. Additives may adversely
affect the engine or transmission
performance and durability.

05/07/01

10:31:35

31SDA630

0209

Changing the Oil and Filter
Always change the oil and filter
according to the maintenance
minder (see page 193 ). The oil and
filter collect contaminants that can
damage your engine if they are not
removed regularly.
Changing the oil and filter requires
special tools and access from
underneath the vehicle. The vehicle
should be raised on a service stationtype hydraulic lift for this service.
Unless you have the knowledge and
proper equipment, you should have
this maintenance done by a skilled
mechanic.
1. Run the engine until it reaches
normal operating temperature,
then shut it off.

WASHER

OIL DRAIN BOLT

4-cylinder models

2. Open the hood, and remove the
engine oil fill cap. Remove the oil
drain bolt and washer from the
bottom of the engine. Drain the oil
into an appropriate container.

OIL DRAIN BOLT

WASHER

6-cylinder models

3. Remove the oil filter and let the
remaining oil drain. A special
wrench (available from your
dealer) is required.
4. Check the oil filter to make sure
its gasket did not stick to the
engine block. A stuck gasket could
cause an oil leak.

206

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/07/01

10:31:50

31SDA630

0210

Changing the Oil and Filter
OIL FILTER

8. Replace the engine oil fill cap.
Start the engine. The oil pressure
indicator should go out within 5
seconds. If it does not, turn off the
engine, and check your work.

OIL FILTER

9. Let the engine run for several
minutes, then check the drain bolt
and oil filter for leaks.

4-cylinder models

6. Put a new washer on the drain bolt,
then reinstall the drain bolt.
Tighten it to:
(4-cylinder models)
33 lbf·ft (45 N·m , 4.6 kgf·m)
(6-cylinder models)
29 lbf·ft (39 N·m , 4.0 kgf·m)

7. Refill the engine with the recommended oil.
Engine oil change capacity
(including filter):
(4-cylinder models)
4.4 US qt (4.2 )
(6-cylinder models)
4.5 US qt (4.3 )

10.Turn off the engine, let it sit for
several minutes, then check the oil
level on the dipstick. If necessary,
add more oil.

Improper disposal of engine oil can be
harmf ul to the environment. If you
change your own oil, please dispose of
the used oil properly. Put it in a sealed
container and take it to a recycling
center. Do not discard it in a trash bin
or dump it on the ground.

207

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Maintenance

5. Install a new oil filter according to
the instructions that come with it.
Make sure to clean off any dirt
and dust on the connecting
surface of a new oil filter.

6-cylinder models

05/07/01

10:32:00

31SDA630

0211

Windshield Washers
Check the level in the windshield
washer reservoir at least monthly
during normal use.

LEVEL GAUGE

LEVEL GAUGE

Check the reservoir’s fluid level by
removing the cap and looking at the
level gauge attached to the cap.
Canadian Models: The low washer
level indicator comes on when the
level is low (see page 63 ).

Fill the reservoir with a good-quality
windshield washer fluid. This
increases the cleaning capability and
prevents freezing in cold weather.
When you refill the reservoir, clean
the edges of the windshield wiper
blades with windshield washer fluid
on a clean cloth. This will help to
condition the blade edges.

4-cylinder models

Do not use engine antif reeze or a
vinegar/water solution in the
windshield washer reservoir. Antif reeze
can damage your vehicle’s paint, while
a vinegar/water solution can damage
the windshield washer pump. Use only
commercially-available windshield
washer f luid.

208

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

6-cylinder models

05/07/01

10:32:09

31SDA630

0212

Engine Coolant
Adding Engine Coolant

4-cylinder models

RESERVE TANK

6-cylinder models

RESERVE TANK

Removing the radiator cap
while the engine is hot can
cause the coolant to spray out,
seriously scalding you.
Always let the engine and
radiator cool down before
removing the radiator cap.

209

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Maintenance

If the coolant level in the reserve
tank is at or below the MIN line, add
coolant to bring it up to the MAX line.
Inspect the cooling system for leaks.
Always use Honda Long-Life
Antifreeze/Coolant Type 2. This
coolant is pre-mixed with 50 percent
antifreeze and 50 percent water.
Never add straight antifreeze or
plain water.

If Honda antifreeze/coolant is not
available, you may use another
major-brand non-silicate coolant as a
temporary replacement. Make sure it
is a high-quality coolant
recommended for aluminum engines.
Continued use of any non-Honda
coolant can result in corrosion,
causing the cooling system to
malfunction or fail. Have the cooling
system flushed and refilled with
Honda antifreeze/coolant as soon as
possible.
If the reserve tank is completely
empty, you should also check the
coolant level in the radiator.

05/07/01

10:32:21

31SDA630

0213

Engine Coolant
6. Pour coolant into the reserve tank.
Fill it to halfway between the MAX
and MIN marks. Put the cap back
on the reserve tank.

RADIATOR CAP

Do not add any rust inhibitors or
other additives to your vehicle’s
cooling system. They may not be
compatible with the coolant or
engine components.
4-cylinder models

1. Make sure the engine and radiator
are cool.
2. Relieve any pressure in the cooling
system by turning the radiator cap
counterclockwise, without
pressing down.
3. Remove the radiator cap by
pushing down and turning
counterclockwise.

6-cylinder models

RADIATOR CAP

4. The coolant level should be up to
the base of the filler neck. Add
coolant if it is low.
Pour the coolant slowly and
carefully so you do not spill any.
Clean up any spill immediately; it
could damage components in the
engine compartment.
5. Put the radiator cap back on and
tighten it.

210

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/07/01

10:32:35

31SDA630

0214

Transmission Fluid
5. If the level is below the lower
mark, remove the fill plug and add
fluid into the tube to bring it to the
upper mark.

Automatic Transmission
4-cylinder models

UPPER MARK
LOWER MARK

Check the fluid level with the engine
at normal operating temperature.
1. Park the vehicle on level ground.
Shut off the engine.
2. Remove the dipstick (yellow loop)
from the transmission, and wipe it
with a clean cloth.

3. Insert the dipstick all the way into
the transmission.
Make sure the rubber cap on the
dipstick fits in the dipstick guide
and that you push the dipstick in
all the way.
4. Remove the dipstick and check
the fluid level. It should be
between the upper and lower
marks.

Always use Honda ATF-Z1
(automatic transmission fluid). If it’s
not available, you may use a
DEXRON III automatic
transmission fluid as a temporary
replacement. However, continued
use can affect the shift quality. Have
the transmission flushed and refilled
with Honda ATF-Z1 as soon as it is
convenient.

CONTINUED

211

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Maintenance

DIPSTICK

Pour the fluid slowly and carefully
so you do not spill any. Clean up
any spill immediately; it could
damage components in the engine
compartment.

05/07/01

10:32:48

31SDA630

0215

Transmission Fluid
To thoroughly flush the transmission,
the technician should drain and refill
it with Honda ATF-Z1 (Automatic
Transmission Fluid), then drive the
vehicle for a short distance. Do this
three times. Then drain and refill the
transmission a final time.

Automatic Transmission
6-cylinder models

6. Insert the dipstick all the way back
into the transmission securely as
shown in the illustration.
The transmission should be drained
and refilled with new fluid according
to the maintenance minder (see page
193 ).
If you are not sure how to add fluid,
contact your dealer.

UPPER MARK
LOWER MARK
DIPSTICK

Check the fluid level with the engine
at normal operating temperature.
1. Park the vehicle on level ground.
Shut off the engine.
2. Remove the dipstick (yellow loop)
from the transmission, and wipe it
with a clean cloth.

212

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

3. Insert the dipstick all the way into
the transmission.
Make sure the rubber cap fits in
the dipstick guide and the dipstick
is down all the way.
4. Remove the dipstick and check
the fluid level. It should be
between the upper and lower
marks.

05/07/01

10:32:58

31SDA630

0216

Transmission Fluid
5. If the level is below the lower
mark, remove the fill plug and add
fluid into the tube to bring it to the
upper mark.
Pour the fluid slowly and carefully
so you do not spill any. Clean up
any spill immediately; it could
damage components in the engine
compartment.

To thoroughly flush the transmission,
the technician should drain and refill
it with Honda ATF-Z1 (Automatic
Transmission Fluid), then drive the
vehicle for a short distance. Do this
three times. Then drain and refill the
transmission a final time.

Always use Honda ATF-Z1
(automatic transmission fluid). If it’s
not available, you may use a
DEXRON III automatic
transmission fluid as a temporary
replacement. However, continued
use can affect the shift quality. Have
the transmission flushed and refilled
with Honda ATF-Z1 as soon as it is
convenient.

5-speed Manual Transmission
FILLER BOLT

Correct level

213

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Maintenance

4-cylinder models

Check the fluid level with the
transmission at normal operating
temperature and the vehicle sitting
on level ground. Remove the
transmission filler bolt, and carefully
feel inside the bolt hole with your
finger.

05/07/01

10:33:07

31SDA630

0217

Transmission Fluid
The fluid level should be up to the
edge of the bolt hole. If it is not, add
Honda Manual Transmission Fluid
(MTF) until it starts to run out of the
hole. Reinstall the filler bolt, and
tighten it securely.
If Honda MTF is not available, you
may use an SAE 10W-30 or 10W-40
viscosity motor oil with the API
Certification seal that says ‘‘FOR
GASOLINE ENGINES’’ as a
temporary replacement. However,
motor oil does not contain the proper
additives, and continued use can
cause stiffer shifting. Replace as
soon as it is convenient.
The transmission should be drained
and refilled with new fluid according
to the maintenance minder (see page
193 ).
If you are not sure how to check and
add fluid, contact your dealer.

6-speed Manual Transmission
EX-V6

FILLER BOLT

Check the fluid level with the
transmission at normal operating
temperature and the vehicle sitting
on level ground.
CHECK BOLT
WASHER

WASHER

DRAIN BOLT

Remove the check bolt and look for
transmission fluid coming out of the
bolt hole. If a small amount of fluid
drips out of the bolt hole, reinstall
the check bolt.

214

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

If no fluid comes out, remove the
filler bolt. Slowly add Honda Manual
Transmission Fluid (MTF) until it
starts to run out of the check bolt
hole. Let the fluid run out until it
stops, then reinstall the check bolt
and the filler bolt.

05/07/01

10:33:20

31SDA630

0218

Transmission Fluid, Brake and Clutch Fluid
Pour the fluid into the filler hole
slowly and carefully so you do not
spill. Clean up any spill immediately;
it could damage components in the
engine compartment.

Brake fluid reservoir (all models)
Clutch fluid reservoir
(manual transmission only)
Replace the brake fluid according to
the maintenance minder (see page
193 ).

Always use Honda Heavy Duty
Brake Fluid DOT 3. If it is not
available, you should use only DOT 3
or DOT 4 fluid, from a sealed
container, as a temporary
replacement.
Using any non-Honda brake fluid can
cause corrosion and decrease the life
of the system. Have the brake
system flushed and refilled with
Honda Heavy Duty Brake Fluid
DOT 3 as soon as possible.
Maintenance

If Honda MTF is not available, you
may use an SAE 10W-30 or 10W-40
viscosity motor oil with the API
Certification seal that says ‘‘FOR
GASOLINE ENGINES’’ as a
temporary replacement. However,
motor oil does not contain the proper
additives, and continued use can
cause stiffer shifting. Replace as
soon as it is convenient.

Brake and Clutch Fluid
Check the fluid level in the
reservoirs monthly. There are up to
two reservoirs, depending on the
model. They are:

Brake fluid marked DOT 5 is not
compatible with your vehicle’s
braking system and can cause
extensive damage.

The transmission should be drained
and refilled with new fluid according
to the maintenance minder (see page
193 ).
If you are not sure how to check and
add fluid, contact your dealer.

CONTINUED

215

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/07/01

10:33:32

31SDA630

0219

Brake and Clutch Fluid, Power Steering Fluid
Brake Fluid

Clutch Fluid
Manual transmission models

Power Steering Fluid
UPPER LEVEL

MAX
MAX

MIN

The fluid level should be between
the MIN and MAX marks on the side
of the reservoir. If the level is at or
below the MIN mark, your brake
system needs attention. Have the
brake system inspected for leaks or
worn brake pads.

4-cylinder models

LOWER LEVEL

MAX

The fluid level should be between
the MIN and MAX marks on the side
of the reservoir. If it is not, add
brake fluid to bring it up to that level.
Use the same fluid specified for the
brake system.
A low fluid level can indicate a leak
in the clutch system. Have this
system inspected as soon as possible.

216

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Check the level on the side of the
reservoir when the engine is cold.
The fluid should be between the
UPPER LEVEL and LOWER LEVEL.
If not, add power steering fluid to the
UPPER LEVEL.

05/07/01

10:33:42

31SDA630

0220

Power Steering Fluid, Timing Belt

UPPER LEVEL

Always use Honda Power Steering
Fluid. You may use another power
steering fluid as an emergency
replacement, but have the power
steering system flushed and refilled
with Honda PSF as soon as possible.
A low power steering fluid level can
indicate a leak in the system. Check
the fluid level frequently, and have
the system inspected as soon as
possible.

6-cylinder models

LOWER LEVEL

Turning the steering wheel to f ull lef t
or right lock and holding it there can
damage the power steering pump.

6-cylinder models

The timing belt should be replaced
according to the maintenance
minder (see page 193 ).
Replace the timing belt every 60,000
miles (U.S.) or every 100,000 km
(Canada) if you regularly drive your
vehicle in any of the following
conditions:
In very high temperatures
(over 110°F, 43°C).
In very low temperatures
(under −20°F, −29°C).
Frequently tow a trailer.

Maintenance

Pour the fluid slowly and carefully
so you do not spill any. Clean up
any spill immediately; it could
damage components in the engine
compartment.

Timing Belt

217

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/06/03

09:52:53

31SDA630

0221

Lights
Headlight Aiming
The headlights were properly aimed
when your vehicle was new. If you
regularly carry heavy items in the
trunk or pull a trailer, readjustment
may be required. Adjustments
should be performed by your dealer
or other qualified mechanic.

Replacing a Headlight Bulb
Your vehicle has two bulbs on each
side, four in total. Make sure you are
replacing the bulb that is burned out.
Your vehicle uses halogen headlight
bulbs. When replacing a bulb, handle
it by its plastic case and protect the
glass from contact with your skin or
hard objects. If you touch the glass,
clean it with denatured alcohol and a
clean cloth.

218

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

NOTE: Halogen headlight bulbs get
very hot when lit. Oil, perspiration, or a
scratch on the glass can cause the bulb
to overheat and shatter.

05/06/03

09:53:02

31SDA630

0222

Lights
High Beam Headlight
FASTENERS

AIR INTAKE
COVER

BULB

AIR INTAKE
COVER
FASTENERS

4-cylinder models

2. Remove the electrical connector
from the bulb by squeezing the
connector to unlock the tab, then
slide the connector off the bulb.

4-cylinder models

TAB

3. Remove the bulb by turning it
approximately one-quarter turn
counterclockwise.
4. Install the new bulb, and turn it
one-quarter turn clockwise to lock
it in place.

CONTINUED

219

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Maintenance

1. Open the hood. To change a bulb
on the passenger’s side, undo the
two fasteners and remove the air
intake cover.

6-cylinder models

05/06/03

09:53:11

31SDA630

0223

Lights
Low Beam Headlight
BULB

HOLDING CLIPS

TAB
6-cylinder models

5. Push the electrical connector onto
the bulb.
6. Turn on the headlights to test the
new bulb.
7. Reinstall the air intake cover.
Reinstall the two fasteners and
secure them by pushing on the
heads until they lock.

BULB

1. To change the passenger’s side
bulb, start the engine, turn the
steering wheel all the way to the
left, and turn off the engine. To
change the driver’s side bulb, turn
the steering wheel to the right.

3. Pull the inner fender cover away
from the fender and bumper.

2. Use a flat-tipped screwdriver to
remove the two holding clips from
the inner fender.

5. Remove the electrical connector
from the bulb by squeezing the
connector to unlock the tab, then
slide the connector off the bulb.

220

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

4. Remove the bulb by turning it
approximately one-quarter turn
counterclockwise.

05/06/03

09:53:21

31SDA630

0224

Lights
6. Install the new bulb, and turn it
one-quarter turn clockwise to lock
it in place.
7. Push the electrical connector onto
the bulb.

Replacing the Front Side Marker/
Turn Signal and Parking Light
Bulb
HOLDING CLIPS

8. Turn on the headlights to test the
new bulb.

BULB

1. To change the passenger’s side
bulb, start the engine, turn the
steering wheel all the way to the
left, and turn off the engine. To
change the driver’s side bulb, turn
the steering wheel to the right.
2. Use a flat-tipped screwdriver to
remove the two holding clips from
the inner fender.

3. Pull the inner fender cover away
from the fender and bumper.
4. Remove the socket from the
headlight assembly by turning it
one-quarter turn counterclockwise.

CONTINUED

221

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Maintenance

9. Put the inner fender cover in place.
Install the two holding clips. Lock
each one in place by pushing on
the center.

05/06/03

09:53:32

31SDA630

0225

Lights
5. To remove the burned out bulb,
push it in and turn it
counterclockwise until it unlocks.

Replacing Rear Turn Signal Light
Bulbs

BULB

HOLDING CLIPS

6. Install the new bulb and turn it
clockwise to lock it in place.
7. Insert the socket into the
headlight assembly. Turn it
clockwise to lock it in place.
SOCKET

8. Test the new bulb to make sure it
works.
9. Put the inner fender cover in place.
Install and lock each holding clip
by pushing on the center.

1. Open the trunk.
2. Remove the holding clips from the
lining by using a flat-tipped
screwdriver.

222

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

3. Remove the socket by turning it
one-quarter turn counterclockwise,
and pull the bulb straight out of its
socket.
4. Push a new bulb straight into the
socket until it bottoms, and
reinstall the socket into the light
assembly by turning it clockwise
until it locks.
5. Test the new bulb to make sure it
works.
6. Set the lining back.

05/06/03

09:53:42

31SDA630

0226

Lights
Replacing Back-up Light Bulbs
TRIM CLIPS

BULB

SOCKET

2. 6-cylinder models
Remove the trim clips from the
right or left corner of the trunk lid
trim by carefully prying them
using a small, flat-tip screwdriver
wrapped with tape.

SOCKET

3. Carefully bend back the corner of
the trunk lid trim to expose the
bulbs.

5. Install a new bulb into the socket,
and reinstall the socket into the
light assembly.

4. Remove the socket by turning it
one-quarter turn counterclockwise,
and pull the bulb straight out of its
socket.

6. Test the light.
7. Push the trunk lid trim back into
position.
8. Press the trim clips back into their
holes.

223

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Maintenance

1. Open the trunk.

BULB

05/06/03

09:53:49

31SDA630

0227

Seat Belts, Floor Mats
Seat Belts

If you use aftermarket floor mats
make sure they fit properly and that
they can be used with the floor mat
anchors. Do not put additional floor
mats on top of the anchored mats.

Floor Mats
LOOP

Clean dirty seat belts with a soft
brush and a mixture of mild soap and
warm water. Do not use bleach, dye,
or cleaning solvents that can weaken
the belt material. Let the belts air
dry before you use the vehicle.
Dirt build-up in the loops of the seat
belt anchors can cause the belts to
retract slowly. Wipe the insides of
the loops with a clean cloth
dampened in mild soap and warm
water or isopropyl alcohol.

The driver’s and right rear floor
mats that came with your vehicle
hook over the floor mat anchors.
This keeps the floor mats from
sliding forward and possibly
interfering with the pedals or
marking the front passenger’s
weight sensors ineffective.
If you remove the floor mats, make
sure to re-anchor them when you put
them back in your vehicle.

224

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/06/03

09:53:55

31SDA630

0228

Wiper Blades
Check the condition of the wiper
blades at least every six months.
Look for signs of cracking in the
rubber, or areas that are getting
hard. Replace the blades if you find
these signs, or if they leave streaks
and unwiped areas when used.

WIPER ARMS

LOCK TAB

1. Raise the wiper arm off the
windshield. Raise the driver’s side
first, then the passenger’s side.

2. Disconnect the blade assembly
from the wiper arm by pushing in
the lock tab. Hold the lock tab in
while you push the blade assembly
toward the base of the arm.

Do not open the hood when the wiper
arms are raised, or you will damage the
hood and wiper arms.

225

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Maintenance

To replace a wiper blade:

05/06/03

09:54:02

31SDA630

0229

Wiper Blades

BLADE

BLADE

5. Slide the new wiper blade into the
holder until the tabs lock.
6. Slide the wiper blade assembly
onto the wiper arm. Make sure it
locks in place.
7. Lower the wiper arm down against
the windshield, the passenger’s
side first, then the driver’s side.

REINFORCEMENT

3. Remove the blade from its holder
by grasping the tabbed end of the
blade. Pull firmly until the tabs
come out of the holder.

4. Examine the new wiper blades. If
they have no plastic or metal
reinforcement along the back
edge, remove the metal
reinforcement strips from the old
wiper blade, and install them in
the slots along the edge of the new
blade.

226

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/06/03

09:54:10

31SDA630

0230

Tires
To safely operate your vehicle, your
tires must be the proper type and
size, in good condition with adequate
tread, and correctly inflated.
The following pages give more
detailed information on how to take
care of your tires and what to do
when they need to be replaced.

Follow all instructions in this
owner’s manual regarding tire
inflation and maintenance.

Underinflated tires wear unevenly,
adversely affect handling and fuel
economy, and are more likely to
fail from being overheated.
Overinflated tires can make your
vehicle ride harshly, are more
prone to damage from road
hazards, and wear unevenly.

Use a gauge to measure the air
pressure in each tire at least once a
month. Even tires that are in good
condition may lose 1 to 2 psi (10 to
20 kPa, 0.1 to 0.2 kgf/cm ) per
month. Remember to check the
spare tire at the same time.
Check the air pressures when the
tires are cold. This means the
vehicle has been parked for at least 3
hours, or driven less than 1 mile (1.6
km). Add or release air, if needed, to
match the recommended cold tire
pressures on the next page.

We recommend that you visually
check your tires every day. If you
think a tire might be low, check it
immediately with a tire gauge.

227

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Maintenance

Using tires that are excessively
worn or improperly inflated can
cause a crash in which you can
be seriously hurt or killed.

Inflation Guidelines
Keeping the tires properly inflated
provides the best combination of
handling, tread life, and riding
comfort.

05/06/03

09:54:24

31SDA630

0231

Tires
If you check air pressures when the
tires are hot (driven for several
miles), you will see readings 4 to 6
psi (30 to 40 kPa, 0.3 to 0.4 kgf/cm )
higher than the cold readings. This
is normal. Do not let air out to match
the recommended cold air pressure.
The tire will be underinflated.
You should get your own tire
pressure gauge whenever you check
your tire pressures. This will make it
easier for you to tell if a pressure
loss is due to a tire problem and not
due to a variation between gauges.
While tubeless tires have some
ability to self-seal if they are
punctured, you should look closely
for punctures if a tire starts losing
pressure.

Recommended Tire Pressures
The following chart shows the
recommended cold tire pressures for
most normal driving conditions.
Tire Size

Cold Tire Pressure
for Normal Driving

P195/65R15 89H *1
P205/60R16 91V *2

Front:
32 psi (220 kPa ,
2.2 kgf/cm )

Rear:
30 psi (210 kPa ,
2.1 kgf/cm )
P205/65R15 92H *3

Front:
30 psi (210 kPa ,
2.1 kgf/cm )

Rear:
29 psi (200 kPa ,
2.0 kgf/cm )

*1 : U.S. VP
*2 : U.S. SE, EX and EX-L
Canadian DX-G, SE and EX-L
*3 : U.S. LX

228

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Tire Size
P215/50R17 93V *4

Cold Tire Pressure
for Normal Driving

Front:
32 psi (220 kPa ,
2.2 kgf/cm )

Rear:
29 psi (200 kPa ,
2.0 kgf/cm )

*4 : U.S. LX-V6 and EX-V6
Canadian SE-V6 and EX-V6

The compact spare tire pressure is:
60 psi (420 kPa , 4.2 kgf/cm )
For convenience, the recommended
tire sizes and cold tire pressures are
on a label on the driver’s doorjamb.
For additional information about
your tires, see page 268 .

05/06/03

09:54:39

31SDA630

0232

Tires
Tire Inspection
Every time you check inflation, you
should also examine the tires for
damage, foreign objects, and wear.

INDICATOR LOCATION MARKS

You should look for:
Bumps or bulges in the tread or
side of the tire. Replace the tire if
you find either of these conditions.

Excessive tread wear.

TREAD WEAR INDICATORS

Your tires have wear indicators
molded into the tread. When the
tread wears down, you will see a
band 1/2 inch (12.7 mm) wide across
the tread. This shows there is less
than 1/16 inch (1.6 mm) of tread left
on the tire.

Have your dealer check the tires if
you feel a consistent vibration while
driving. A tire should always be
rebalanced if it is removed from the
wheel. When you have new tires
installed, make sure they are
balanced. This increases riding
comfort and tire life. For best results,
have the installer perform a dynamic
balance.

A tire this worn gives very little
traction on wet roads. You should
replace the tire if you can see three
or more tread wear indicators.

229

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Maintenance

Cuts, splits, or cracks in the side
of the tire. Replace the tire if you
can see fabric or cord.

Tire Maintenance
In addition to proper inflation,
correct wheel alignment helps to
decrease tire wear. If you find a tire
is worn unevenly, have your dealer
check the wheel alignment.

05/06/07

17:19:24

31SDA630

0233

Tires
U.S. SE, EX, EX-L, LX-V6 and EX-V6
All Canadian models

Tire Rotation
Front

Front

Improper wheel weights can damage
your vehicle’s aluminum wheels. Use
only genuine Honda wheels weights f or
balancing.

(For Non-directional (For Directional
Tires and Wheels)
Tires and Wheels)

To help increase tire life and
distribute wear more evenly, rotate
the tires according to the
maintenance messages displayed in
the odometer/outside temperature
display. Move the tires to the
positions shown in the chart each
time they are rotated. If you
purchase directional tires, rotate
only front-to-back.

230

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/06/03

09:54:52

31SDA630

0234

Tires
Replacing Tires and Wheels
Replace your tires with radial tires of
the same size, load range, speed
rating, and maximum cold tire
pressure rating (as shown on the
tire’s sidewall).
Mixing radial and bias-ply tires on
your vehicle can reduce braking
ability, traction, and steering
accuracy. Using tires of a different
size or construction can cause the
ABS to work inconsistently.

Installing improper tires on your
vehicle can affect handling and
stability. This can cause a crash
in which you can be seriously
hurt or killed.

Wheels and Tires
Wheels
U.S. VP and LX:
Canadian DX-G:
15 x 6 1/2 JJ
U.S. SE, EX and EX-L:
Canadian SE and EX-L:
16 x 6 1/2 JJ
U.S. LX-V6 and EX-V6:
Canadian SE-V6 and EX-V6:
17 x 6 1/2 JJ
Maintenance

It is best to replace all four tires at
the same time. If that is not possible
or necessary, replace the two front
tires or two rear tires as a pair.
Replacing just one tire can seriously
affect your vehicle’s handling.

If you ever replace a wheel, make
sure that the wheel’s specifications
match those of the original wheels.
Replacement wheels are available at
your dealer.

Always use the size and type of
tires recommended in this
owner’s manual.

231

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/06/03

09:55:02

31SDA630

0235

Tires
Tires
U.S. VP:
P195/65R15 89H
U.S. LX:
P205/65R15 92H
U.S. SE, EX and EX-L:
Canadian DX-G, SE and EX-L:
P205/60R16 91V
U.S. LX-V6 and EX-V6:
Canadian SE-V6 and EX-V6:
P215/50R17 93V
See page 269 for DOT tire quality
grading information, and page
271 for tire size information.

Winter Driving
Tires marked ‘‘M + S’’ or ‘‘All
Season’’ on the sidewall have an allweather tread design suitable for
most winter driving conditions.

Mount snow chains on your tires
when required by driving conditions
or local laws. Install them only on the
front tires.

For the best performance in snowy
or icy conditions, you should install
snow tires or tire chains. They may
be required by local laws under
certain conditions.

Because your vehicle has limited tire
clearance, Honda strongly
recommends using the chains listed
below, made by Security Chain
Company (SCC).

Snow Tires

If you mount snow tires on your
vehicle, make sure they are radial
tires of the same size and load range
as original tires. Mount snow tires on
all four wheels. The traction
provided by snow tires on dry roads
may be lower than your original tires.
Check with the tire dealer for
maximum speed recommendations.

232

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Tire Chains

05/07/01

10:33:49

31SDA630

0236

Tires
U.S. VP and LX

Link-type: SCC Quick Grip QG1134
U.S. SE, EX and EX-L
Canadian DX-G, SE and EX-L

Link-type: SCC Quick Grip QG1134
Cable-types: SCC Radial Chain
CH2311T or SCC SC Cable SC1030
The chains listed above are
available at most retail parts and
accessory stores that carry SCC
Products.

When installing cables, follow the
manufacturer’s instructions, and
mount them as tight as you can.
Make sure they are not contacting
the brake lines or suspension. Drive
slowly with them installed. If you
hear them coming into contact with
the body or chassis, stop and
investigate. Remove them as soon as
you begin driving on cleared roads.

Using the wrong chains, or not
properly installing chains, can
damage the brake lines and
cause a crash in which you can
be seriously injured or killed.
Follow all instructions in this
owner’s manual regarding the
selection and use of tire chains.
Maintenance

U.S. LX-V6 and EX-V6
Canadian SE-V6 and EX-V6

Cable-type: SCC SZ 134
The SCC SZ 134 chain is available
from your dealer as a Genuine
Honda Accessory (part number
08W40-SDA-SZ134).

233

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/06/03

09:55:14

31SDA630

0237

Checking the Battery
TEST INDICATOR WINDOW

TEST INDICATOR WINDOW

If additional battery maintenance is
needed, see your dealer or a
qualified mechanic.
WARNING: Battery posts,
terminals, and related accessories
contain lead and lead compounds.
Wash your hands after handling.

4-cylinder models

Check the condition of the battery
monthly by looking at the test
indicator window. The label on the
battery explains the test indicator’s
colors.

6-cylinder models

Check the terminals for corrosion (a
white or yellowish powder). To
remove it, cover the terminals with a
solution of baking soda and water. It
will bubble up and turn brown. When
this stops, wash it off with plain
water. Dry off the battery with a
cloth or paper towel. Coat the
terminals with grease to help prevent
future corrosion.

234

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

If you need to connect the battery to
a charger, disconnect both cables to
prevent damaging your vehicle’s
electrical system. Always disconnect
the negative (−) cable first, and
reconnect it last.

05/06/03

09:55:20

31SDA630

0238

Checking the Battery, Vehicle Storage

The battery gives off explosive
hydrogen gas during normal
operation.
A spark or flame can cause the
battery to explode with enough
force to kill or seriously hurt you.

Vehicle Storage
If you need to park your vehicle for
an extended period (more than 1
month), there are several things you
should do to prepare it for storage.
Proper preparation helps prevent
deterioration and makes it easier to
get your vehicle back on the road. If
possible, store your vehicle indoors.

Fill the fuel tank.
Change the engine oil and filter.
Wash and dry the exterior
completely.
Clean the interior. Make sure the
carpeting, floor mats, etc., are
completely dry.

Maintenance

Wear protective clothing and a
face shield, or have a skilled
mechanic do the battery
maintenance.

235

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/06/03

09:55:27

31SDA630

0239

Vehicle Storage
Leave the parking brake off. Put
the transmission in Reverse
(manual transmission) or Park
(automatic transmission).
Block the rear wheels.
If the vehicle is to be stored for a
longer period, it should be
supported on jackstands so the
tires are off the ground.
Leave one window open slightly (if
the vehicle is being stored
indoors).
Disconnect the battery.

Support the front wiper blade
arms with a folded towel or rag so
they do not touch the windshield.
To minimize sticking, apply a
silicone spray lubricant to all door
and trunk seals. Also, apply a
vehicle body wax to the painted
surfaces that mate with the door
and trunk seals.
Cover the vehicle with a
‘‘breathable’’ cover, one made
from a porous material such as
cotton. Non-porous materials, such
as plastic sheeting, trap moisture,
which can damage the paint.
If possible, periodically run the
engine until it reaches full
operating temperature (the
cooling fan cycles twice).
Preferably, do this once a month.

236

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/06/03

09:55:31

31SDA630

0240

Taking Care of the Unexpected
This section covers the more
common problems that motorists
experience with their vehicles. It
gives you information about how to
safely evaluate the problem and what
to do to correct it. If the problem has
stranded you on the side of the road,
you may be able to get going again.
If not, you will also find instructions
on getting your vehicle towed.

237

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Taking Care of the Unexpected

Compact Spare Tire....................... 238
Changing a Flat Tire ..................... 239
If the Engine Won’t Start .............. 243
Nothing Happens or the
Starter Motor Operates
Very Slowly............................. 243
The Starter Operates
Normally ................................. 244
Jump Starting ................................. 245
If the Engine Overheats ............... 248
Low Oil Pressure Indicator .......... 250
Charging System Indicator........... 251
Malfunction Indicator Lamp ........ 251
Readiness Codes ........................ 252
Brake System Indicator ................ 253
Closing the Moonroof ................... 254
Emergency Towing ....................... 255
Fuses ............................................... 257
Fuse Locations ............................... 260

05/06/03

09:55:41

31SDA630

0241

Compact Spare Tire
Use the compact spare tire as a
temporary replacement only. Get
your regular tire repaired or replaced,
and put it back on your vehicle as
soon as you can.

Do not mount snow chains on the
compact spare tire.
Do not use the compact spare tire
if you are towing a trailer.

Check the inflation pressure of the
compact spare tire every time you
check the other tires. It should be
inflated to:
60 psi (420 kPa , 4.2 kgf/cm )

Do not use your compact spare
tire on another vehicle unless it is
the same make and model.

Follow these precautions:

Turn off the VSA system (see
pages 182 and 183 ). Driving with
the compact spare tire may
activate the VSA.

Never exceed 50 mph (80 km/h).
This tire gives a harsher ride and
less traction on some road surfaces. Use greater caution while
driving.

INDICATOR LOCATION MARK

U.S. LX-V6 and EX-V6
Canadian SE-V6 and EX-V6

On models with manual
transmission, do not drive for a
long period with the compact
spare tire mounted on a front
wheel; it will damage the limited
slip differential.

238

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

TREAD WEAR INDICATOR BAR

Replace the tire when you can see
the tread wear indicator bars. The
replacement should be the same size
and design tire, mounted on the
same wheel. The spare tire is not
designed to be mounted on a regular
wheel, and the spare wheel is not
designed for mounting a regular tire.

05/06/03

09:55:49

31SDA630

0242

Changing a Flat Tire
If you have a flat tire while driving,
stop in a safe place to change it.
Drive slowly along the shoulder until
you get to an exit or an area that is
far away from the traffic lanes.

3. The tools are in the trunk. Open
the trunk and raise the trunk floor
by lifting up on the back edge.

TRUNK FLOOR

4. Take the tool kit out of the trunk.
5. Unscrew the wing bolt and take
the spare tire out of its well.

The vehicle can easily roll off
the jack, seriously injuring
anyone underneath.
TOOL KIT

SPARE TIRE

1. Park the vehicle on firm, level and
non-slippery ground. Put the
transmission in Park (automatic)
or reverse (manual). Apply the
parking brake.
2. Turn on the hazard warning lights,
and turn the ignition switch to the
LOCK (0) position. Have all
passengers get out of the vehicle
while you change the tire.
CONTINUED

239

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Taking Care of the Unexpected

Follow the directions for
changing a tire exactly, and
never get under the vehicle
when it is supported only by the
jack.

JACK

05/06/03

09:55:56

31SDA630

0243

Changing a Flat Tire

JACK

6. The jack is behind a cover in the
right fender. Remove the cover by
turning the handle counterclockwise, then pulling on the cover.

JACKING POINT

7. Turn the jack’s end bracket
counterclockwise to loosen it, then
remove the jack.
8. Loosen each wheel nut 1/2 turn
with the wheel wrench.

240

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

9. Place the jack under the jacking
point nearest the tire you need to
change. Turn the end bracket
clockwise until the top of the jack
contacts the jacking point. Make
sure the jacking point tab is
resting in the jack notch.

05/06/03

09:56:02

31SDA630

0244

Changing a Flat Tire
EXTENSION

11.Remove the wheel nuts and flat
tire. Place the flat tire on the
ground with the outside surface of
the wheel facing up.

WHEEL WRENCH

BRAKE HUB

If a wheel cover is equipped

Do not attempt to forcibly pry the
wheel cover off with a screwdriver
or other tool. The wheel cover
cannot be removed without first
removing the wheel nuts.
CONTINUED

241

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Taking Care of the Unexpected

12.Before mounting the spare tire,
wipe any dirt off the mounting
surface of the wheel and hub with
a clean cloth. Wipe the hub
carefully; it may be hot from
driving.

10.Use the extension and the wheel
nut wrench as shown to raise the
vehicle until the flat tire is off the
ground.

05/06/03

09:56:12

31SDA630

0245

Changing a Flat Tire
WING BOLT

16.Remove the center cap before
storing the flat tire in the trunk
well.
17.Place the flat tire face down in the
spare tire well.
18.Remove the spacer cone from the
wing bolt, turn it over, and put it
back on the bolt.

SPACER CONE

13.Put on the spare tire. Put the
wheel nuts back on finger-tight,
then tighten them in a crisscross
pattern with the wheel nut wrench
until the wheel is firmly against
the hub. Do not try to tighten
them fully.

15.Tighten the wheel nuts securely in
the same crisscross pattern. Have
the wheel nut torque checked at
the nearest automotive service
facility.
Tighten the wheel nuts to:
80 lbf·ft (108 N·m , 11 kgf·m)

14.Lower the vehicle to the ground,
and remove the jack.

242

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

19.Secure the flat tire by screwing
the wing bolt back into its hole.
20.Store the jack in its holder. Turn
the jack’s end bracket to lock it in
place. Replace the cover. Store the
tools.

05/06/03

09:56:21

31SDA630

0246

Changing a Flat Tire, If the Engine Won’t Start

Loose items can fly around the
interior in a crash and could
seriously injure the occupants.
Store the wheel, jack, and tools
securely before driving.
21.Store the wheel cover or center
cap in the trunk. Make sure it does
not get scratched or damaged.

If the Engine Won’t Start
Diagnosing why the engine won’t
start falls into two areas, depending
on what you hear when you turn the
ignition switch to the START (III)
position:
You hear nothing, or almost
nothing. The engine’s starter
motor does not operate at all, or
operates very slowly.

Check these things:
Check the transmission interlock.
If you have a manual transmission,
the clutch pedal must be pushed
all the way to the floor or the
starter will not operate. With an
automatic transmission, it must be
in Park or neutral.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON
(II) position. Turn on the
headlights, and check their
brightness. If the headlights are
very dim or do not come on at all,
the battery is discharged. See
Jump Starting on page 245 .
CONTINUED

243

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Taking Care of the Unexpected

You can hear the starter motor
operating normally, or the starter
motor sounds like it is spinning
faster than normal, but the engine
does not start up and run.

Nothing Happens or the Starter
Motor Operates Very Slowly
When you turn the ignition switch to
the START (III) position, you do not
hear the normal noise of the engine
trying to start. You may hear a
clicking sound or series of clicks, or
nothing at all.

05/06/03

09:56:28

31SDA630

0247

If the Engine Won’t Start
Turn the ignition switch to the
START (III) position. If the
headlights do not dim, check the
condition of the fuses. If the fuses
are OK, there is probably
something wrong with the
electrical circuit for the ignition
switch or starter motor. You will
need a qualified mechanic to
determine the problem (see
Emergency Towing on page 255 ).
If the headlights dim noticeably or
go out when you try to start the
engine, either the battery is discharged or the connections are
corroded. Check the condition of
the battery connections (see page
234 ). You can then try jump
starting the vehicle from a booster
battery (see page 245 ).

The Starter Operates Normally
In this case, the starter motor’s
speed sounds normal, or even faster
than normal, when you turn the
ignition switch to the START (III)
position, but the engine does not run.
Are you using the proper starting
procedure? Refer to Starting the
Engine on page 169 .
Are you using a properly coded
key? An improperly coded key will
cause the immobilizer system
indicator in the instrument panel
to blink rapidly (see page 75 ).

244

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Do you have fuel? Check the fuel
gauge; the low fuel indicator may
not be working.
There may be an electrical
problem, such as no power to the
fuel pump. Check all the fuses
(see page 257 ).
If you find nothing wrong, you will
need a qualified mechanic to find the
problem. See Emergency Towing
on page 255 .

05/06/03

09:56:38

31SDA630

0248

Jump Starting
Although this seems like a simple
procedure, you should take several
precautions.

A battery can explode if you do
not follow the correct procedure,
seriously injuring anyone
nearby.

To jump start your vehicle:
1. Open the hood, and check the
physical condition of the battery.
In very cold weather, check the
condition of the electrolyte. If it
seems slushy or frozen, do not try
jump starting until it thaws.

If a battery sits in extreme cold, the
electrolyte inside can f reeze.
Attempting to jump start with a f rozen
battery can cause it to rupture.

You cannot start your vehicle by
pushing or pulling it.

2. Turn off all the electrical accessories: heater, A/C, climate
control, stereo system, lights, etc.
Put the transmission in Neutral or
Park, and set the parking brake.

4-cylinder models

BOOSTER
BATTERY

The numbers in the illustration show
the order to connect the jumper
cable.

CONTINUED

245

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Taking Care of the Unexpected

Keep all sparks, open flames,
and smoking materials away
from the battery.

05/06/03

09:56:43

31SDA630

0249

Jump Starting
3. Connect one jumper cable to the
positive (+) terminal on your
battery. Connect the other end to
the positive (+) terminal on the
booster battery.

BOOSTER
BATTERY
6-cylinder models

4-cylinder models

4. Connect the second jumper cable
to the negative (−) terminal on
the booster battery. Connect the
other end to the grounding strap
as shown. Do not connect this
jumper cable to any other part of
the engine.

246

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/06/03

09:56:48

31SDA630

0250

Jump Starting
7. Once your vehicle is running,
disconnect the negative cable from
your vehicle, then from the
booster battery. Disconnect the
positive cable from your vehicle,
then from the booster battery.

6-cylinder models

Keep the ends of the jumper
cables away from each other and
any metal on the vehicle until
everything is disconnected.
Otherwise, you may cause an
electrical short.

Taking Care of the Unexpected

5. If the booster battery is in another
vehicle, have an assistant start
that vehicle and run it at a fast idle.
6. Start the vehicle. If the starter
motor still operates slowly, check
that the jumper cables have good
metal-to-metal contact.

247

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/06/07

17:19:32

31SDA630

0251

If the Engine Overheats
The pointer of the vehicle’s
temperature gauge should stay in
the midrange. If it climbs to the red
mark, you should determine the
reason (hot day, driving up a steep
hill, etc.).
If your vehicle overheats, you should
take immediate action. The only
indication may be the temperature
gauge climbing to or above the red
mark. Or you may see steam or
spray coming from under the hood.

Driving with the temperature gauge
pointer at the red mark can cause
serious damage to the engine.

Steam and spray from an
overheated engine can
seriously scald you.
Do not open the hood if steam
is coming out.
1. Safely pull to the side of the road.
Put the transmission in Neutral or
Park, and set the parking brake.
Turn off all accessories, and turn
on the hazard warning lights.
2. If you see steam and/or spray
coming from under the hood, turn
off the engine. Wait until you see
no more signs of steam or spray,
then open the hood.

248

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

3. If you do not see steam or spray,
leave the engine running, and
watch the temperature gauge. If
the high heat is due to overloading,
the engine should start to cool
down almost immediately. If it
does, wait until the temperature
gauge comes down to the midpoint,
then continue driving.
4. If the temperature gauge stays at
the red mark, turn off the engine.
5. Look for any obvious coolant leaks,
such as a split radiator hose.
Everything is still extremely hot,
so use caution. If you find a leak, it
must be repaired before you
continue driving (see Emergency
Towing on page 255 ).

05/06/03

09:57:03

31SDA630

0252

If the Engine Overheats
6. If you do not find an obvious leak,
check the coolant level in the
radiator reserve tank. Add coolant
if the level is below the MIN mark.
7. If there was no coolant in the
reserve tank, you may need to add
coolant to the radiator. Let the
engine cool down until the pointer
reaches the middle of the temperature gauge, or lower, before checking the radiator.

9. Start the engine and set the
temperature control dial to
maximum (climate control to
FULL AUTO at 90°F/32°C). Add
coolant to the radiator up to the
base of the filler neck. If you do
not have the proper coolant
mixture available, you can add
plain water. Remember to have
the cooling system drained and
refilled with the proper mixture as
soon as you can.

10.Put the radiator cap back on
tightly. Run the engine, and watch
the temperature gauge. If it goes
back to the red mark, the engine
needs repair (see Emergency
Towing on page 255 ).
11.If the temperature stays normal,
check the coolant level in the
radiator reserve tank. If it has
gone down, add coolant to the
MAX mark. Put the cap back on
tightly.
Taking Care of the Unexpected

Removing the radiator cap
while the engine is hot can
cause the coolant to spray out,
seriously scalding you.

8. Using gloves or a large heavy
cloth, turn the radiator cap
counterclockwise, without pushing
down, to the first stop. After the
pressure releases, push down on
the cap, and turn it until it comes
off.

Always let the engine and
radiator cool down before
removing the radiator cap.

249

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/07/01

10:33:58

31SDA630

0253

Low Oil Pressure Indicator

LOW OIL PRESSURE INDICATOR

Running the engine with low oil
pressure can cause serious mechanical
damage almost immediately. Turn of f
the engine as soon as you can saf ely get
the vehicle stopped.
1. Safely pull off the road, and shut
off the engine. Turn on the hazard
warning lights.
This indicator should never come on
when the engine is running. If it
starts flashing or stays on, the oil
pressure has dropped very low or
lost pressure. Serious engine
damage is possible, and you should
take immediate action.

2. Let the vehicle sit for a minute.
Open the hood, and check the oil
level (see page 159 ). An engine
very low on oil can lose pressure
during cornering and other driving
maneuvers.
3. If necessary, add oil to bring the
level back to the full mark on the
dipstick (see page 204 ).

250

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

4. Start the engine and watch the oil
pressure indicator. If it does not go
out within 10 seconds, turn off the
engine. There is a mechanical
problem that needs to be repaired
before you can continue driving
(see Emergency Towing on page
255 ).

05/06/03

09:57:18

31SDA630

0254

Charging System Indicator, Malfunction Indicator Lamp
Charging System Indicator
CHARGING SYSTEM INDICATOR

Immediately turn off all electrical
accessories. Try not to use other
electrically operated controls such as
the power windows. Keep the engine
running; starting the engine will
discharge the battery rapidly.
Go to a service station or garage
where you can get technical
assistance.

MALFUNCTION INDICATOR LAMP

If the indicator comes on while
driving, it means one of the engine’s
emission control systems may have a
problem. Even though you may feel
no difference in your vehicle’s
performance, continued operation
may cause serious damage.

CONTINUED

251

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Taking Care of the Unexpected

If the charging system indicator
comes on brightly when the engine
is running, the battery is not being
charged.

Malfunction Indicator Lamp

05/06/03

09:57:24

31SDA630

0255

Malfunction Indicator Lamp
If you have recently refueled your
vehicle, the cause of this indicator
coming on could be a loose or
missing fuel fill cap. Check the cap
or replace it. Tightening the cap will
not make the indicator turn off
immediately; it can take several
days of normal driving.

Readiness Codes
Your vehicle has certain ‘‘readiness
codes’’ that are part of the on-board
diagnostics for the emissions
systems. In some states, part of the
emissions testing is to make sure
these codes are set. If they are not
set, the test cannot be completed.

If the indicator remains on or the
fuel cap was not loose or missing,
have the vehicle checked by the
dealer as soon as possible.

If your vehicle’s battery has been
disconnected or gone dead, these
codes are erased. It can take several
days of driving under various
conditions to set the codes again.

If you keep driving with the
Malf unction Indicator Lamp on, you
can damage your vehicle’s emissions
controls and engine. Those repairs may
not be covered by your vehicle’s
warranties. This indicator may also
come on with the ‘‘D’’ indicator.

252

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

To check if they are set, turn the
ignition switch to the ON (II)
position, without starting the engine.
The malfunction indicator lamp will
come on for 20 seconds. If it then
goes off, the readiness codes are set.
If it blinks five times, the readiness
codes are not set. If possible, do not
take your vehicle for a state
emissions test until the readiness
codes are set. Refer to State
Emissions Testing for more
information (see page 275).

05/06/03

09:57:30

31SDA630

0256

Brake System Indicator

BRAKE SYSTEM INDICATOR

However, if the brake pedal does not
feel normal, you should take
immediate action. A problem in one
part of the system’s dual circuit
design will still give you braking at
two wheels. You will feel the brake
pedal go down much farther before
the vehicle begins to slow down, and
you will have to press harder on the
pedal.

U.S. models shown

Slow down by shifting to a lower
gear, and pull to the side of the road
when it is safe. Because of the long
distance needed to stop, it is
hazardous to drive the vehicle. You
should have it towed and repaired as
soon as possible (see Emergency
Towing on page 255 ).
If you must drive the vehicle a short
distance in this condition, drive
slowly and carefully.

253

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Taking Care of the Unexpected

If the ABS indicator comes on with
this indicator, have the vehicle
inspected by your dealer
immediately.

If this indicator comes on while
driving, the brake fluid level is
probably low in the reservoir. Press
lightly on the brake pedal to see if it
feels normal. If it does, check the
brake fluid level the next time you
stop at a service station (see page
215 ). If the fluid level is low, take
the vehicle to your dealer and have
the brake system inspected for leaks
or worn brake pads.

05/06/03

09:57:39

31SDA630

0257

Closing the Moonroof
U.S. EX, EX-L, LX-V6 and EX-V6
Canadian SE, EX-L, SE-V6 and EX-V6

ROUND PLUG

SOCKET

If the electric motor will not close
the moonroof, do the following:
1. Check the fuse for the moonroof
motor (see page 257 ). If the fuse
is blown, replace it with one of the
same or lower rating.
2. Try closing the moonroof. If the
new fuse blows immediately or the
moonroof motor still does not
operate, you can close the
moonroof manually.
3. Get the moonroof wrench out of
the tool kit in the trunk.

4. Use a screwdriver or coin to
remove the round plug in the
center of the headliner.
5. Insert the moonroof wrench into
the socket behind this plug. Turn
the wrench until the moonroof is
fully closed.
6. Remove the wrench. Reinstall the
round plug.

254

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

If you need to close the moonroof
manually, it means the moonroof
opening/closing function is
developing a problem. Have your
vehicle checked by your dealer.

05/06/07

17:21:51

31SDA630

0258

Emergency Towing
If your vehicle needs to be towed,
call a professional towing service or
organization. Never tow your vehicle
with just a rope or chain. It is very
dangerous.
There are two ways to tow your
vehicle:
Flat-bed Equipment − The operator
loads your vehicle on the back of a
truck. This is the best way to transport your vehicle.

Manual Transmission:

Release the parking brake.
Shift the transmission to neutral.
Leave the ignition switch in the
ACCESSORY (I) position so the
steering wheel does not lock.
Automatic Transmission:

Release the parking brake.
Start the engine.
Shift to D, then to N.
Turn off the engine.
Leave the ignition switch in the
ACCESSORY (I) position so the
steering wheel does not lock.

Improper towing preparation will
damage the transmission. Follow the
above procedure exactly. If you cannot
shif t the transmission or start the
engine (automatic transmission), your
vehicle must be transported with the
f ront wheels of f the ground.
With the front wheels on the ground,
it is best to tow the vehicle no farther
than 50 miles (80 km), and keep the
speed below 35 mph (55 km/h).

CONTINUED

255

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Taking Care of the Unexpected

Wheel-lift Equipment − The tow
truck uses two pivoting arms that go
under the tires (front) and lift them
off the ground. The other two tires
remain on the ground. This is an
acceptable way to tow your
vehicle.

If, due to damage, your vehicle must
be towed with the front wheels on
the ground, do this:

05/06/07

17:21:54

31SDA630

0259

Emergency Towing

Trying to lif t or tow your vehicle by the
bumpers will cause serious damage.
The bumpers are not designed to
support the vehicle’s weight.

The steering system can be damaged if
the steering wheel is locked. Leave the
ignition switch in the ACCESSORY (I)
position, and make sure the steering
wheel turns f reely bef ore you begin
towing.

256

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/06/03

09:58:02

31SDA630

0260

Fuses
INTERIOR

UNDER-HOOD

TAB

The under-hood fuse box is located
near the back of the engine compartment on the driver’s side. To open it,
push the tabs as shown.

1. Turn the ignition switch to the
LOCK (0) position. Make sure the
headlights and all other
accessories are off.
2. Remove the cover from the fuse
box.

CONTINUED

257

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Taking Care of the Unexpected

The interior fuse box is on the
driver’s lower left side. To remove
the fuse box lid, pull it toward you
and take it out of its hinges.

Checking and Replacing Fuses
If something electrical in your
vehicle stops working, the first thing
you should check for is a blown fuse.
Determine from the chart on pages
260 and 261 , or the diagram on the
fuse box lid, which fuse or fuses
control that component. Check those
fuses first, but check all the fuses
before deciding that a blown fuse is
not the cause. Replace any blown
fuses and check if the device works.

05/06/03

09:58:08

31SDA630

0261

Fuses
BLOWN

BLOWN

BLOWN

3. Check each of the large fuses in
the under-hood fuse box by
looking at the wire inside.
Removing these fuses requires a
Phillips-head screwdriver.

4. Check the smaller fuses in the
under-hood fuse box and all the
fuses in the interior fuse box by
pulling out each one with the fuse
puller provided in the under-hood
fuse box.
5. Look for a burned wire inside the
fuse. If it is burned out, replace it
with one of the spare fuses of the
same rating or lower.

258

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/06/03

09:58:12

31SDA630

0262

Fuses

FUSE PULLER

6. If the replacement fuse of the
same rating blows in a short time,
there is probably a serious
electrical problem with your
vehicle. Leave the blown fuse in
that circuit, and have your vehicle
checked by a qualified mechanic.

Replacing a f use with one that has a
higher rating greatly increases the
chances of damaging the electrical
system. If you do not have a
replacement f use with the proper rating
f or the circuit, install one with a lower
rating.

Taking Care of the Unexpected

If you cannot drive the vehicle
without fixing the problem, and you
do not have a spare fuse, take a fuse
of the same rating or a lower rating
from one of the other circuits with
the fuse puller provided in the underhood fuse box. Make sure you can
do without that circuit temporarily
(such as the accessory power socket
or radio).

If you replace the blown fuse with a
spare fuse that has a lower rating, it
might blow out again. This does not
indicate anything wrong. Replace the
fuse with one of the correct rating as
soon as you can.

259

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/06/03

09:58:21

31SDA630

0263

Fuse Locations
No. Amps.

UNDER-HOOD FUSE/RELAY BOX

14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22

40 A
40 A
15 A
30 A
30 A
20 A
40 A
40 A
40 A
40 A
100 A
−

23

No. Amps.
1
2
3
4
5
6
7

10 A
(30A)
10 A
15 A
10 A
10 A
7.5 A

Circuits Protected
Left Headlight Low
(Rear Defroster Coil)*1
Left Headlight Hi
Small Light
Right Headlight Hi
Right Headlight Low
Back Up

No. Amps.
8
9
10
11
12
13

15 A
20 A
−

20 A
30 A
7.5 A
20 A

50 A
50 A

Circuits Protected
Rear Defroster
Back Up, ACC
Hazard
ABS Motor*2
VSA Motor*3
ABS F/S*2
VSA Motor*3
Driver’s Power Seat
Passenger’s Power Seat*4
Heater Motor
Battery
Not Used
+B IG1 Main
Power Window Main

Circuits Protected
FI ECU
Condenser fan
Not Used
Cooling Fan*2
Cooling Fan*3
MG. Clutch
Horn, Stop

260

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

*1 : U.S. EX, EX-L LX-V6 and EX-V6
Canadian SE, EX-L, SE-V6 and EX-V6
*2 : U.S. VP, LX, SE, EX and EX-L
Canadian DX-G, SE and EX-L
*3 : U.S. LX-V6 and EX-V6
Canadian SE-V6 and EX-V6
*4 : Except Canadian DX-G

05/06/03

09:58:29

31SDA630

0264

Fuse Locations
No. Amps.

INTERIOR FUSE BOX

1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8

(15 A)
15 A
(10 A)
15 A
10 A
7.5 A
10 A
20 A

Circuits Protected
Drive by Wire
Ignition Coil
Day Light
Laf Heater
Radio
Interior Light
Back-Up Lights
Door Lock

No. Amps.
15 A
7.5 A
30 A

9
10
11
12
13

(20 A)

14
15

(20 A)
(20 A)

−

Circuits Protected
Front Accessory Sockets
IG OPDS
IG Wiper
Not Used
Passenger’s Power Seat
Recline*2
Driver’s Power Seat Slide*2
Heated Seat*2

(20 A)
(20 A)
15 A
15 A
7.5 A
7.5 A
10 A
7.5 A
20 A
20 A
20 A
20 A
(20 A)
−

7.5 A
−

7.5 A
7.5 A

Circuits Protected
Driver’s Power Seat Recline*2
Passenger’s Power Seat Slide*2
IG ACG
IG Fuel Pump
IG Washer
IG Meter
IG SRS
IGP (PGM-FI ECU)
Left Rear Power Window
Right Rear Power Window
Right Front Power Window
Driver’s Power Window
Moonroof *3
Not Used
IG HAC
Not Used
ACC
HAC OP

*1 : U.S. models
*2 : U.S. EX, EX-L, LX-V6 and EX-V6
Canadian EX-L, SE-V6 and EX-V6
*3 : U.S. EX, EX-L, LX-V6 and EX-V6
Canadian SE, EX-L, SE-V6 and EX-V6

261

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Taking Care of the Unexpected

No. Amps.

16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/06/03

09:58:35

31SDA630

0266

Technical Information
The diagrams in this section give
you the dimensions and capacities of
your vehicle, and the locations of the
identification numbers. It also
includes information you should
know about your vehicle’s tires and
emissions control systems.

Replacement Parts..................... 273
Three Way Catalytic Converter ... 274
State Emissions Testing ............... 275

Technical Information

Identification Numbers ................. 264
Specifications ................................. 266
DOT Tire Quality Grading
(U. S. Vehicles) ...................... 269
Uniform Tire Quality
Grading ................................... 269
Treadwear .................................. 269
Traction....................................... 269
Temperature .............................. 270
Tire Labeling .................................. 271
Emissions Controls........................ 272
The Clean Air Act ...................... 272
Crankcase Emissions Control
System..................................... 272
Evaporative Emissions Control
System..................................... 272
Onboard Refueling Vapor
Recovery ................................. 272
Exhaust Emissions Controls .... 273
PGM-FI System ..................... 273
Ignition Timing Control
System................................. 273
Exhaust Gas Recirculation
(EGR) System .................... 273
Three Way Catalytic
Converter ............................ 273

263

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/06/03

09:58:39

31SDA630

0267

Identification Numbers
Your vehicle has several identifying
numbers in various places.

VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION NUMBER

The Vehicle Identification Number
(VIN) is the 17-digit number your
Honda dealer uses to register your
vehicle for warranty purposes. It is
also necessary for licensing and
insuring your vehicle. The easiest
place to find the VIN is on a plate
fastened to the top of the dashboard.
You can see it by looking through
the windshield on the driver’s side. It
is also on the Certification label
attached to the driver’s doorjamb,
and is stamped on the engine
compartment bulkhead. The VIN is
also provided in bar code on the
Certification label.

CERTIFICATION LABEL

264

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/06/03

09:58:46

31SDA630

0268

Identification Numbers
The engine number is stamped on
the front of the engine block.

4-cylinder Models
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION NUMBER

The transmission number is on a
label on top of the transmission.

6-cylinder Models
ENGINE NUMBER

ENGINE
NUMBER

MANUAL
TRANSMISSION
NUMBER

AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION NUMBER

Technical Information

265

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/06/03

09:59:04

31SDA630

0269

Specifications
Dimensions
Length
Width
Height
Wheelbase
Track

Front
Rear

Weights
Gross vehicle weight rating

Air Conditioning
Refrigerant type
Charge quantity
Lubricant type
Capacities
Fuel tank
Engine
coolant

See the certification label attached
to the driver’s doorjamb.

HFC-134a (R-134a)
25−27 oz (700−750 g)
16−18 oz (450−500 g)*1
ND-OIL8

Approx.
17.09 US gal (64.7 )
Change*2
Manual
Automatic
Total
Manual
Automatic

Capacities
Engine oil

189.5 in (4,813 mm)
71.7 in (1,820 mm)
57.2 in (1,453 mm)
107.9 in (2,740 mm)
61.1 in (1,553 mm)
61.2 in (1,554 mm)

1.35 US gal (5.1 )
1.32 US gal (5.0 )
1.77 US gal (6.7 ) *1

Change*3
Including
filter
Without
filter
Total

Manual trans- Change
mission oil
Total
Automatic
Change
transmission
fluid
Total
Windshield
washer
reservoir

U.S.
Canada

4.4 US qt (4.2 )
4.5 US qt (4.3 )
4.2 US qt (4.0 )
5.6 US qt (5.3
5.3 US qt (5.0
2.0 US qt (1.9
2.3 US qt (2.2
2.2 US qt (2.1
2.6 US qt (2.5
3.1 US qt (2.9
3.2 US qt (3.0
6.9 US qt (6.5
7.4 US qt (7.0
2.6 US qt (2.5
4.8 US qt (4.5

)
)
)
)
)
)
)
)
)
)
)
)

*1

*1

*1

*1

*1

*1

*1 : 6-cylinder models
*2 : Including the coolant in the reserve tank and that remaining in the
engine.
Reserve tank capacity: 0.16 US gal (0.6 )
*3 : Excluding the oil remaining in the engine.

1.90 US gal (7.2 )
1.88 US gal (7.1 )
2.22 US gal (8.4 ) *1

266

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/06/03

09:59:21

31SDA630

0270

Specifications
Lights
Headlights

High
Low
Front turn signal/
Front parking lights
Rear turn signal lights
Back-up lights
License plate light
Ceiling light
Spotlights*1
Spotlights/Front ceiling lights*2
Trunk light
Door courtesy light
Vanity mirror lights*3

12 V − 60 W (HB3)
12 V − 51 W (HB4)
12 V − 24/2.2 CP
12 V
12 V
12 V
12 V
12 V
12 V
12 V
12 V
12 V

−
−
−
−
−
−
−
−
−

21 W
21 W
3 CP
8W
8W
8W
5W
2 CP
1.1 W

Battery
Capacity
4-cylinder
6-cylinder
Fuses
Interior

Under-hood

12 V − 36 AH/5 HR
12 V − 38 AH/5 HR
12 V − 52 AH/5 HR

See page 261 or the fuse label
attached to the inside of the fuse
box door on each side of the
dashboard.
See page 260 or the fuse box
cover.

*1 : U.S. LX, SE and LX-V6
Canadian SE and SE-V6
*2 : U.S. EX, EX-L and EX-V6
Canadian EX-L and EX-V6
*3 : Except U.S. VP and Canadian DX-G

Technical Information

CONTINUED

267

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/06/03

09:59:36

31SDA630

0271

Specifications
Engine
Type

Bore x Stroke
Displacement
Compression ratio
Spark plugs

Water cooled 4-stroke, DOHC
i-VTEC 4-cylinder, SOHC VTEC
6-cylinder (V6), gasoline engine
3.43 x 3.9 in (87.0 x 99.0 mm) *3
3.39 x 3.39 in (86.0 x 86.0 mm) *4
143.6 cu-in (2,354 cm ) *3
182.8 cu-in (2,997 cm ) *4
9.7 : 1 *3
10 : 1 *4
NGK:
IZFR6K-11*3, *4
DENSO: SKJ20DR-M11*3, *4
IZFR6K-13 *3, *5
NGK:
DENSO: SKJ20DR-M13 *3, *5

*3 : 4-cylinder models
*4 : 6-cylinder models
*5 : On some models
Alignment
Toe-in
Camber
Caster

Front
Rear
Front
Rear
Front

Tires
Size

Front/Rear

Pressure

Spare
Front
Rear
Spare

*1 : U.S. VP
*2 : U.S. LX
*3 : U.S. SE, EX and EX-L
Canadian DX-G, SE and EX-L
*4 : U.S. LX-V6 and EX-V6
Canadian SE-V6 and EX-V6

0.00 in (0.0 mm)
0.08 in (2.0 mm)
0°
−1°
3°15’

268

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

P195/65R15 89H *1
P205/65R15 92H *2
P205/60R16 91V *3
P215/50R17 93V *4
T135/90D15
32 psi (220 kPa , 2.2 kgf/cm ) *1, *3, *4
30 psi (210 kPa , 2.1 kgf/cm ) *2
30 psi (210 kPa , 2.1 kgf/cm ) *1, *3
29 psi (200 kPa , 2.0 kgf/cm ) *2, *4
60 psi (420 kPa , 4.2 kgf/cm )

05/06/03

09:59:44

31SDA630

0272

DOT Tire Quality Grading (U.S. Vehicles)
The tires on your vehicle meet all
U.S. Federal Safety Requirements.
All tires are also graded for
treadwear, traction, and temperature
performance according to
Department of Transportation
(DOT) standards. The following
explains these gradings.

Traction − AA, A, B, C
The traction grades, from highest to
lowest, are AA, A, B, and C. Those
grades represent the tire’s ability to
stop on wet pavement as measured
under controlled conditions on
specified government test surfaces
of asphalt and concrete. A tire
marked C may have poor traction
performance.
Warning: The traction grade
assigned to this tire is based on
straight-ahead braking traction tests,
and does not include acceleration,
cornering, hydroplaning, or peak
traction characteristics.
Technical Information

Uniform Tire Quality Grading
Quality grades can be found where
applicable on the tire sidewall
between the tread shoulder and the
maximum section width. For
example:
Treadwear 200
Traction AA
Temperature A

Treadwear
The treadwear grade is a comparative rating based on the wear rate of
the tire when tested under controlled
conditions on a specified government
test course. For example, a tire
graded 150 would wear one and onehalf (1 1/2) times as well on the
government course as a tire graded
100. The relative performance of
tires depends upon the actual conditions of their use, however, and may
depart significantly from the norm
due to variations in driving habits,
service practices, and differences in
road characteristics and climate.

All passenger vehicle tires must
conform to Federal Safety
Requirements in addition to these
grades.

269

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/06/03

09:59:48

31SDA630

0273

DOT Tire Quality Grading (U.S. Vehicles)
Temperature − A, B, C
The temperature grades are A (the
highest), B, and C, representing the
tire’s resistance to the generation of
heat and its ability to dissipate heat
when tested under controlled
conditions on a specified indoor
laboratory test wheel. Sustained high
temperature can cause the material
of the tire to degenerate and reduce
tire life, and excessive temperature
can lead to sudden tire failure. The
grade C corresponds to a level of
performance, which all passenger
vehicle tires must meet under the
Federal Motor Vehicle Safety
Standard No. 109. Grades B and A
represent higher levels of
performance on the laboratory test
wheel than the minimum required by
law.

Warning: The temperature grade for
this tire is established for a tire that
is properly inflated and not
overloaded. Excessive speed,
underinflation, or excessive loading,
either separately or in combination,
can cause heat buildup and possible
tire failure.

270

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/06/03

10:00:04

31SDA630

0274

Tire Labeling
16 − Rim diameter in inches.

Tire Labeling
The tires that came on your vehicle
have a number of markings. Those
you should be aware of are described
below.

91 − Load index (a numerical code
associated with the maximum
load the tire can carry).

Tire Size

V

Whenever tires are replaced, they
should be replaced with tires of the
same size. Following is an example
of tire size with an explanation of
what each component means.
P205/60R16 91V
P

− Vehicle type (P indicates
passenger vehicle).

60 − Aspect ratio (the tire’s section
height as a percentage of its
width).
R

− Tire construction code (R
indicates radial).

Tire Identification Number

Maximum Tire Pressure

Max Press − The maximum air
pressure the tire can
hold.
Maximum Tire Load

Max Load − The maximum load the
tire can carry at
maximum air pressure.

The tire identification number (TIN)
is a group of numbers and letters
that look like the following example
TIN.
DOT B97R FW6X 2202
DOT − This indicates that the tire
meets all requirements of
the U.S. Department of
Transportation.

Technical Information

205 − Tire width in millimeters.

− Speed symbol (an
alphabetical code indicating
the maximum speed rating).

2202 − Date of manufacture.

B97R − Manufacturer’s
identification mark.
FW6X − Tire type code.

271

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/06/03

10:00:13

31SDA630

0275

Emissions Controls
The burning of gasoline in your
vehicle’s engine produces several byproducts. Some of these are carbon
monoxide (CO), oxides of nitrogen
(NOx), and hydrocarbons (HC).
Gasoline evaporating from the tank
also produces hydrocarbons. Controlling the production of NOx, CO,
and HC is important to the environment. Under certain conditions of
sunlight and climate, NOx and HC
react to form photochemical ‘‘smog.’’
Carbon monoxide does not contribute to smog creation, but it is a
poisonous gas.

The Clean Air Act
The United States Clean Air Act*
sets standards for automobile
emissions. It also requires that
automobile manufacturers explain to
owners how their emissions controls
work and what to do to maintain
them. This section summarizes how
the emissions controls work.
*
In Canada, Honda vehicles comply
with the Canadian emission
requirements, as specified in an
agreement with Environment
Canada, at the time they are
manufactured.

Crankcase Emissions Control
System
Your vehicle has a positive
crankcase ventilation system. This
keeps gasses that build up in the
engine’s crankcase from going into
the atmosphere. The positive
crankcase ventilation valve routes
them from the crankcase back to the

272

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

intake manifold. They are then
drawn into the engine and burned.
Evaporative Emissions Control
System
As gasoline evaporates in the fuel
tank, an evaporative emissions
control canister filled with charcoal
adsorbs the vapor. It is stored in this
canister while the engine is off. After
the engine is started and warmed up,
the vapor is drawn into the engine
and burned during driving.
Onboard Refueling Vapor
Recovery
The onboard refueling vapor
recovery (ORVR) system captures
the fuel vapors during refueling. The
vapors are adsorbed in a canister
filled with activated carbon. While
driving, the fuel vapors are drawn
into the engine and burned off.

05/06/03

10:00:22

31SDA630

0276

Emissions Controls
Exhaust Emissions Controls
The exhaust emissions controls
include four systems: PGM-FI,
ignition timing control, exhaust gas
recirculation, and three way catalytic
converter. These four systems work
together to control the engine’s
combustion and minimize the
amount of HC, CO, and NOx that
comes out the tailpipe. The exhaust
emissions control systems are
separate from the crankcase and
evaporative emissions control
systems.
PGM-FI System

Ignition Timing Control System

This system constantly adjusts the
ignition timing, reducing the amount
of HC, CO, and NOx produced.
Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR)
System

The exhaust gas recirculation (EGR)
system takes some of the exhaust
gas and routes it back into the intake
manifold. Adding exhaust gas to the
air/fuel mixture reduces the amount
of NOx produced when the fuel is
burned.

Replacement Parts
The emissions control systems are
designed and certified to work together in reducing emissions to
levels that comply with the Clean Air
Act. To make sure the emissions
remain low, you should use only new
Honda replacement parts or their
equivalent for repairs. Using lower
quality parts may increase the
emissions from your vehicle.
The emissions control systems are
covered by warranties separate from
the rest of your vehicle. Read your
warranty manual for more information.
Technical Information

The PGM-FI system uses sequential
multiport fuel injection. It has three
subsystems: air intake, engine
control, and fuel control. The
powertrain control module (PCM) in
automatic transmission vehicles or
the engine control module (ECM) in
manual transmission vehicles uses
various sensors to determine how
much air is going into the engine. It

then controls how much fuel to inject
under all operating conditions.

Three Way Catalytic Converter

The three way catalytic converter is
in the exhaust system. Through
chemical reactions, it converts HC,
CO, and NOx in the engine’s exhaust
to carbon dioxide (CO2), nitrogen
(N2), and water vapor.

273

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/06/03

10:00:29

31SDA630

0277

Three Way Catalytic Converter
The three way catalytic converter
contains precious metals that serve
as catalysts, promoting chemical
reactions to convert the exhaust
gasses without affecting the metals.
The catalytic converter is referred to
as a three-way catalyst, since it acts
on HC, CO, and NOx. A replacement
unit must be an original Honda part
or its equivalent.
The three way catalytic converter
must operate at a high temperature
for the chemical reactions to take
place. It can set on fire any
combustible materials that come
near it. Park your vehicle away from
high grass, dry leaves, or other
flammables.

THREE WAY CATALYTIC CONVERTER
4-cylinder models

A defective three way catalytic
converter contributes to air pollution,
and can impair your engine’s performance. Follow these guidelines to
protect your vehicle’s three way
catalytic converter.
Always use unleaded gasoline.
Even a small amount of leaded
gasoline can contaminate the
catalyst metals, making the three
way catalytic converter ineffective.

274

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

THREE WAY CATALYTIC CONVERTERS
6-cylinder models

Keep the engine tuned-up.
Have your vehicle diagnosed and
repaired if it is misfiring, backfiring, stalling, or otherwise not
running properly.

05/06/03

10:00:36

31SDA630

0278

State Emissions Testing
Testing of Readiness Codes
If you take your vehicle for a state
emissions test shortly after the
battery has been disconnected or
gone dead, it may not pass the test.
This is because of certain ‘‘readiness
codes’’ that must be set in the onboard diagnostics for the emissions
systems. These codes are erased
when the battery is disconnected,
and set again only after several days
of driving under a variety of
conditions.

If the testing facility determines that
the readiness codes are not set, you
will be requested to return at a later
date to complete the test. If you must
get the vehicle retested within the
next two or three days, you can
condition the vehicle for retesting by
doing the following.
Make sure the gas tank is nearly,
but not completely full (around
3/4).

Without touching the accelerator
pedal, start the engine, and let it
idle for 20 seconds.
Keep the vehicle in Park
(automatic transmission) or
Neutral (manual transmission).
Increase the engine speed to 2,000
rpm, and hold it there until the
temperature gauge rises to at least
1/4 of the scale (about 3 minutes).

Make sure the vehicle has been
parked with the engine off for 6
hours or more.

CONTINUED

275

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Technical Information

Make sure the ambient
temperature is between 40° and
95°F.

05/06/03

10:00:41

31SDA630

0279

State Emissions Testing
Select a nearby lightly traveled
major highway where you can
maintain a speed of 50 to 60 mph
(80 to 97 km/h) for at least 20
minutes. Drive on the highway in
D (A/T) or 5th (M/T). Do not use
the cruise control. When traffic
allows, drive for 90 seconds
without moving the accelerator
pedal. (Vehicle speed may vary
slightly; this is okay.) If you cannot
do this for a continuous 90
seconds because of traffic
conditions, drive for at least 30
seconds, then repeat it two more
times (for a total of 90 seconds).

Then drive in city/suburban
traffic for at least 10 minutes.
When traffic conditions allow, let
the vehicle coast for several
seconds without using the
accelerator pedal or the brake
pedal.
If the testing facility determines the
readiness codes are still not set, see
your dealer.

276

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/06/03

10:00:44

31SDA630

0280

Warranty and Customer Relations

277

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Warranty and Customer Relations

Customer Service Information..... 278
Warranty Coverages ..................... 279
Reporting Safety Defects
(U.S. Vehicle) ............................. 280
Authorized Manuals ...................... 281

05/06/03

10:00:52

31SDA630

0281

Customer Service Information
Honda dealership personnel are
trained professionals. They should
be able to answer all your questions.
If you encounter a problem that your
dealership does not solve to your
satisfaction, please discuss it with
the dealership’s management. The
service manager or general manager
can help. Almost all problems are
solved in this way.
If you are dissatisfied with the
decision made by the dealership’s
management, contact your Honda
Customer Service Office.

U.S. Owners:
American Honda Motor Co., Inc.
Automobile Customer Service
Mail Stop 500-2N-7A
1919 Torrance Boulevard
Torrance, California 90501-2746
Tel: (800) 999-1009

Canadian Owners:
CUSTOMER RELATIONS
RELATIONS AVEC LA CLIENTÉLE
Honda Canada Inc.
715 Milner Avenue
Toronto, ON
M1B 2K8
Tel: 1-888-9-HONDA-9
Fax: Toll-free 1-877-939-0909
Toronto (416) 287-4776

278

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

In Puerto Rico and the U.S. Virgin
Islands:
Bella International
P.O. Box 190816
San Juan, Puerto Rico 00919-0816
(787) 250-4318

When you call or write, please give
us this information:
Vehicle Identification Number
(see page 264 )
Name and address of the dealer
who services your vehicle
Date of purchase
Mileage on your vehicle
Your name, address, and telephone number
A detailed description of the
problem
Name of the dealer who sold the
vehicle to you

05/06/03

10:01:02

31SDA630

0282

Warranty Coverages
U.S. Owners
Your new vehicle is covered by these
warranties:

Emissions Control Systems Defects
Warranty and Emissions
Performance Warranty − these two

warranties cover your vehicle’s
emissions control systems. Time,
mileage, and coverage are
conditional. Please read your
warranty booklet for exact
information.
Original Equipment Battery Limited
Warranty − this warranty gives up

to 100 percent credit toward a
replacement battery.

Rust Perforation Limited Warranty

− all exterior body panels are
covered for rust-through from the
inside for the specified time period
with no mileage limit.
Accessory Limited Warranty −
Honda accessories are covered
under this warranty. Time and
mileage limits depend on the type of
accessory and other factors. Please
read your warranty booklet for
details.
Replacement Parts Limited
Warranty − covers all Honda

replacement parts against defects in
materials and workmanship.

Replacement Battery Limited
Warranty − provides prorated

coverage for a replacement battery
purchased from your dealer.
Replacement Muffler Lifetime
Limited Warranty − provides

coverage for as long as the purchaser of the muffler owns the
vehicle.
Restrictions and exclusions apply to
all these warranties. Please read the
2006 Honda Warranty Information
booklet that came with your vehicle
for precise information on warranty
coverages. Your vehicle’s original
tires are covered by their
manufacturer. Tire warranty
information is in a separate booklet.
Canadian Owners
Please refer to the 2006 Warranty
Manual that came with your vehicle.

279

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Warranty and Customer Relations

New Vehicle Limited Warranty −
covers your new vehicle, except for
the battery, emissions control
systems, and accessories, against
defects in materials and
workmanship.

Seat Belt Limited Warranty − a seat
belt that fails to function properly is
covered for the useful life of the
vehicle.

05/07/01

10:34:04

31SDA630

0283

Reporting Safety Defects (U.S. Vehicles)
If you believe that your vehicle has a
defect which could cause a crash or
could cause injury or death, you
should immediately inform the
National Highway Traffic Safety
Administration (NHTSA), in addition
to notifying American Honda Motor
Co., Inc.

If NHTSA receives similar complaints, it may open an investigation,
and if it finds that a safety defect
exists in a group of vehicles, it may
order a recall and remedy campaign.
However, NHTSA cannot become
involved in individual problems
between you, your dealer, or
American Honda Motor Co., Inc.

280

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

To contact NHTSA, you may call the
Vehicle Safety Hotline toll-free at 1888-327-4236 (TTY 1-800-424-9153);
go to http://www.safercar.gov; or
write to: Administrator, NHTSA, 400
Seventh Street, SW., Washington,
DC 20590.
You can also obtain other
information about motor vehicle
safety from http://www.safercar.gov.

05/06/03

10:01:15

31SDA630

0284

Authorized Manuals
Purchasing Factory Authorized Manuals (U.S. only)
The publications shown below can be purchased from Helm
Incorporated. You can order in any of three ways:
Detach and mail the order form on the right half of this page
Call Helm Inc. at 1-800-782-4356 (credit card orders only)
Go online at www. helminc. com
If you are interested in other years or models, contact Helm Inc.
at 1-800-782-4356.
Publication
Form Number
61SDA08

61SDA08EL
61SDA30
31SDA630
31SDA730
31SDAM10
31SDDM10
31SDAQ30
HON-R
*

2003-2006 Honda Accord 2/4 door L4
Service Manual Base Book
2003-2006 Honda Accord 2/4 door V6
Service Manual Supplement
2003-2006 Honda 2/4 Door L4/V6
Electrical Troubleshooting Manual
2003-2006 Honda 2/4 door
Body Repair Manual
2006 Honda Accord 4-door Owner’s Manual
2006 Honda Accord
Navigation System Owner’s Manual
2006 Honda Accord L4 Honda Service History
2006 Honda Accord V6 Honda Service History
2006 Honda Accord 4-door Quick Start Guide
Order Form for Previous YearsIndicate Year and Model Desired

ORDER TOLL FREE: 1-800-782-4356
(NOTE: For Credit Card Holder Orders Only)
Monday-Friday 8:00 A.M. − 6:00 P.M. EST
MINIMUM CREDIT CARD PURCHASE $10.00

OR

Price
Each*
$75.00

By completing this form you can order the materials desired. You can
pay by check or money order, or charge to your credit card. Mail to
Helm Incorporated at the address shown on the back of the order form.

$45.00
$50.00

VEHICLE MODEL

2
0
0
6

PUBLICATION NUMBER

Price

Total

Each*

Price

Qty
Name

Year

$44.00
$35.00
$29.00
$12.00
$12.00
$12.00
FREE

H
O
N
*
Prices are subject to change without
notice and without incurring obligation.

Orders are mailed within 10 days. Please
allow adequate time for delivery.

TOTAL MATERIAL
Mich. Purchases
Add 6% Sales Tax
HANDLING CHARGE

$6.95

GRAND TOTAL

Prices are subject to change without notice and without incurring obligation.

281

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Authorized Manuals

61SDA09

Form Description

Valid only for sales within the United States. Canadian
owners should contact their authorized Honda dealer.

05/06/03

10:01:24

31SDA630

0285

Authorized Manuals
Service Manual:
This manual covers maintenance and recommended
procedures for repair to engine and chassis components.
It is written for the journeyman mechanic, but is simple
enough for most mechanically-inclined owners to understand.

NOTE: Dealers and Companies please provide dealer or company name,
and also the name of the person to whose attention the shipment should
be sent. For purchases outside U.S.A. please write to the address shown
below for a quotation.

S
H
I
P
T
O

Customer Name

Attention

Street Address − No P.O. Box Number

Apartment Number

City

State & Zip Code

Daytime Telephone Number

P
A
Y
M
E
N
T

(

Electrical Troubleshooting Manual:
This manual complements the service manual by
providing in-depth troubleshooting information for each
electrical circuit in your vehicle.

)

Body Repair Manual:
This manual describes the procedures involved in the
replacement of damaged body parts.

Check or money order enclosed payable to Helm Inc − U.S. funds only.
Do not send cash
Master
Card

VISA

Check here if your billing address is different
from the shipping address shown above.

Account Number

Expiration: Mo. Yr.
−

CUSTOMER SIGNATURE

DATE

These Publications cannot be returned for credit without receiving advance authorization within 14
days of delivery. On returns, a restocking fee may be applied against the original order.

P.O. BOX 07280·DETROIT, MICHIGAN 48207·1-800-782-4356

282

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/07/01

10:34:10

31SDA630

0286

Index
A

Battery
Charging System
Indicator............................ 58, 251
Jump Starting ............................. 245
Maintenance ............................... 234
Specifications ............................. 267
Before Driving ............................... 153
Belts, Seat ......................................... 10
Brakes
Anti-lock System (ABS) ............ 180
Break-in, New Linings .............. 154
Fluid ............................................ 215
Parking .......................................... 99
System Indicator .......................... 59
Wear Indicators ......................... 179
Braking System.............................. 179
Break-in, New Car ......................... 154
Brightness Control, Instruments ... 72
Brights, Headlights ......................... 70
Bulb Replacement
Back-up Lights ........................... 223
Brake Lights............................... 223
Front Parking Lights ................. 221
Headlights .................................. 218

Specifications ............................. 267
Turn Signal Lights............. 221, 222
Bulbs, Halogen ............................... 218

C
Capacities Chart............................. 266
Carbon Monoxide Hazard .............. 52
Carrying Cargo .............................. 164
CAUTION, Explanation of ............... ii
CD Changer.................................... 128
CD Player........................................ 122
CD Pocket, Center........................... 99
Certification Label ......................... 264
Chains ............................................. 232
Changing a Flat Tire ..................... 239
Changing Oil
How to ......................................... 206
When to....................................... 193
Charging System Indicator .... 58, 251
Checklist, Before Driving ............. 168
Childproof Door Locks ................... 78
INDEX

Accessories..................................... 162
ACCESSORY (Ignition Key
Position) ........................................ 76
Accessory Power Socket ................ 99
Additives, Engine Oil..................... 205
Airbag (SRS) .................................... 11
Airbag System Components ........... 23
Air Conditioning............................. 105
Usage .......................................... 107
Air Pressure, Tires ........................ 228
Anti-lock Brakes (ABS)
Indicator ................................ 59, 180
Operation .................................... 180
Anti-theft Steering Column Lock .. 78
Audio System ......... 114, 122, 131, 135
Automatic Speed Control.............. 145
Automatic Transmission............... 173
Capacity, Fluid ........................... 266
Shifting ........................................ 173
Shift Lever Position Indicator .. 173
Shift Lever Positions ................. 173
Shift Lock Release ..................... 176

B

CONTINUED

I

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/07/01

10:34:16

31SDA630

0287

Index
Child Seats ........................................ 34
Lower Anchorage Points ............ 43
Tether Anchorage Points ........... 47
Climate Control Sensors ............... 113
Clock, Setting the .......................... 143
Clutch Fluid .................................... 215
CO in the Exhaust ......................... 274
Cold Weather, Starting in ............. 169
Compact Spare ............................... 238
Console Compartment .................... 99
Consumer Information.................. 278
Controls, Instruments and .............. 55
Coolant
Adding ......................................... 209
Checking ..................................... 160
Proper Solution .......................... 209
Temperature Gauge .................... 65
Crankcase Emissions Control
System......................................... 274
Cruise Control Operation ............. 145
Customer Service Office .............. 278

Daytime Running Lights................. 70
Defects, Reporting Safety............. 280
Defogger, Rear Window ................. 72
Dimensions ..................................... 266
Dimming the Headlights ................ 69
Dipstick
Automatic Transmission .. 211, 212
Engine Oil ................................... 159
Directional Signals ........................... 69
Disc Brake Wear Indicators ......... 179
Disposal of Used Oil ...................... 207
Doors
Locking and Unlocking ............... 77
DOT Tire Quality Grading ........... 269
Downshifting, Manual
Transmission .............................. 170
Driver and Passenger Safety ............ 7
Driving ............................................ 167
Economy ..................................... 161
Dual Temperature Control ........... 111

E
D
DANGER, Explanation of ................. ii
Dashboard .................................... 4, 56

Economy, Fuel ............................... 161
Emergencies on the Road............. 237
Battery, Jump Starting .............. 245

II

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Brake System Indicator ............ 253
Changing a Flat Tire ................. 239
Charging System Indicator ...... 251
Checking the Fuses................... 257
Low Oil Pressure Indicator ...... 250
Malfunction Indicator Lamp .... 251
Manually Closing Moonroof .... 254
Overheated Engine ................... 248
Emergency Brake ............................ 95
Emergency Flashers ....................... 71
Emergency Towing ....................... 255
Emissions Controls........................ 272
Engine
Coolant Temperature Gauge ..... 65
Malfunction Indicator
Lamp ....................................... 251
Oil Life Indicator........................ 193
Oil Pressure Indicator ............... 250
Oil, What Kind to Use ............... 204
Overheating................................ 248
Specifications ............................. 266
Speed Limiter ..................... 172, 175
Starting........................................ 169
Engine Speed Limiter ........... 172, 175
Evaporative Emissions Controls .. 272
Exhaust Fumes ................................ 52

05/07/01

10:34:24

31SDA630

0288

Index
Expectant Mothers, Use of Seat
Belts by ......................................... 18

F

G
Gas Mileage, Improving................ 161
Gasoline .......................................... 154
Gauge ............................................ 66
Octane Requirement ................. 154
Tank, Filling the......................... 156
Gas Station Procedures................. 156
Gauges
Engine Coolant Temperature .... 65
Fuel ................................................ 66
Speedometer ................................ 64
Tachometer .................................. 64
Gearshift Lever Positions
Automatic Transmission........... 173
Manual Transmission ............... 170
Glove Box ....................................... 100

H
Halogen Headlight Bulbs.............. 218
Hazard Warning Flashers............... 71
Headlights......................................... 69
Aiming ......................................... 218
Automatic Lighting Off ............... 70
Daytime Running Lights............. 71
Low Beams, Turning on ............. 69
Reminder Chime .......................... 69
Replacing Halogen Bulbs ......... 218
Turning on .................................... 69
Head Restraints ............................... 87
Heating and Cooling ...................... 102
Heated Mirror .................................. 91
HomeLink Universal
Transceiver................................. 148
Hood, Opening and Closing the ... 157
Hydraulic Clutch ............................ 215

INDEX

Fan, Interior.................................... 104
Features .......................................... 101
Filling the Fuel Tank ..................... 156
Filter
Oil ................................................ 206
Manual Transmission
Checking Fluid Level ................ 214
Manual Transmission
Shifting the ................................. 170
Flashers, Hazard Warning.............. 71
Flat Tire, Changing a .................... 239
Fluids
Automatic Transmission .. 211, 212
Brake ........................................... 215
Clutch .......................................... 215
Manual Transmission ............... 214
Power Steering........................... 216
Windshield Washer ................... 208
Folding Rear Seat ............................ 88
Four-way Flashers ........................... 71

Fuel .................................................. 154
Cap Message ................................ 66
Fill Door and Cap....................... 156
Gauge ............................................ 66
Octane Requirement ................. 154
Tank, Filling the......................... 156
Fuses, Checking the ...................... 257

CONTINUED

III

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/07/01

10:34:31

31SDA630

0289

Index
I
Identification Number, Vehicle.... 264
Ignition
Keys............................................... 74
Switch ............................................ 76
Timing Control System ............. 273
Immobilizer System......................... 75
Important Safety Precautions .......... 8
Indicators, Instrument Panel .......... 58
Infant Restraint ................................ 38
Infant Seats ....................................... 38
Tether Anchorage Points ........... 47
Inflation, Proper Tire .................... 227
Inside Mirror .................................... 90
Inspection, Tire .............................. 229
Installing a Child Seat ..................... 42
Tether Anchorage Points ........... 47
Using LATCH .............................. 43
Instrument Panel ............................. 57
Instrument Panel Brightness ......... 71
Introduction ......................................... i

J
Jacking up the Vehicle .................. 240

Jack, Tire ........................................ 239
Jump Starting ................................. 245

K
Keys ................................................... 74

L
Label, Certification ........................ 264
Lane Change, Signaling .................. 69
Lap/Shoulder Belts ......................... 20
Lights
Bulb Replacement ..................... 218
Indicator ........................................ 57
Parking ........................................ 221
Turn Signal ................................... 61
LOCK (Ignition Key Position) ....... 76
Locks
Anti-theft Steering Column ........ 76
Fuel Fill Door ............................. 156
Glove Box ................................... 100
Lockout Prevention ..................... 78
Power Door .................................. 77
Trunk ............................................ 82
Low Coolant Level ......................... 160

IV

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

Lower Gear, Downshifting to a.... 170
Low Oil Pressure Indicator ............ 58
Lubricant Specifications Chart .... 266
Luggage .......................................... 164

M
Maintenance ................................... 191
Minder .............................. 193−199
Owner’s Maintenance
Checks .................................... 198
Record ......................................... 200
Safety........................................... 192
Malfunction Indicator Lamp ........ 251
Manual Transmission.................... 170
Manual Transmission Fluid ......... 214
Meters, Gauges ................................ 64
Mirrors, Adjusting ........................... 90
Modifications.................................. 163
Moonroof .......................................... 94
Closing Manually ....................... 254
Operation ...................................... 94

05/07/01

10:34:39

31SDA630

0290

Index
N
Neutral Gear Position.................... 174
New Vehicle Break-in ................... 154
Normal Shift Speeds...................... 171
NOTICE, Explanation of .................... i
Numbers, Identification ................ 264

O

Panel Brightness Control ............... 71
Park Gear Position......................... 174
Parking Brake .................................. 95
Parking Lights.................................. 69
Parking Over Things that Burn ... 276
Parking Tips ................................... 178
PGM-FI System.............................. 273
Pregnancy, Using Seat Belts .......... 18
Protecting Adults and Teens.......... 13
Additional Safety Precautions .... 19
Advice for Pregnant Women...... 18
Protecting Children ......................... 34
Protecting Infants and Small
Children ........................................ 38
Protecting Larger Children ............ 48
Using Booster Seat ...................... 49

R
Radiator Overheating .................... 248
Radio/CD Sound
System ................ 118, 119, 122, 123
Rear Lights, Bulb
Replacement ....................... 222, 223

Rear Seat, Folding ........................... 88
Rear View Mirror ............................. 90
Rear Window Defogger .................. 72
Reclining the Seat Backs ................ 86
Recommended Shift Speeds ........ 171
Reminder Lights .............................. 58
Remote Transmitter ........................ 78
Replacement Information
Engine Oil and Filter ................. 206
Fuses ........................................... 257
Light Bulbs ................................. 218
Timing Belt ................................. 217
Tires ............................................ 231
Wiper Blades .............................. 225
Replacing Seat Belts After a
Crash ............................................. 22
Reserve Tank, Coolant .................. 209
Restraint, Child ................................ 34
Reverse Gear Position........... 172, 174
Rotation, Tire ................................. 230
INDEX

Octane Requirement, Gasoline .... 154
Odometer .......................................... 64
Odometer/Outside Temperature
Display ......................................... 64
Oil
Change, How to ......................... 206
Change, When to ....................... 193
Checking Engine ....................... 159
Pressure Indicator ............... 58, 250
Selecting Proper Viscosity
Chart ....................................... 205
ON (Ignition Key Position) ............ 76
Outside Mirrors ............................... 90
Outside Temperature ...................... 64
Overheating, Engine ..................... 248
Owner’s Maintenance Checks ..... 198

P

CONTINUED

V

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/07/01

10:34:44

31SDA630

0291

Index
S
Safety Belts....................................... 10
Safety Defects, Reporting............. 280
Safety Features .................................. 9
Airbags .......................................... 11
Seat Belts ...................................... 10
Safety Labels, Location of .............. 53
Safety Messages ................................ ii
Satellite Radio................................. 135
Seat Belts .......................................... 10
Additional Information ................ 20
Automatic Seat Belt
Tensioners ................................ 21
Lap/Shoulder Belt ....................... 20
Maintenance ................................. 22
Reminder Light and
Beeper ................................. 20, 58
System Components.................... 20
Use During Pregnancy................ 18
Wearing a Lap/Shoulder Belt .... 20
Seats, Adjusting the................. 85−87
Security System ............................. 144
Selecting a Child Seat ...................... 41
Serial Number ................................ 264
Service Minder..................... 193−199

Service Manual .............................. 281
Service Station Procedure ............ 156
Setting the Clock ........................... 143
Shift Lever Position Indicator ...... 173
Shift Lock Release ......................... 176
Side Airbags ............................... 11, 28
How Your Side Airbags Work.... 28
How the Side Airbag Off
Indicator Works ....................... 29
Side Curtain Airbags ................. 11, 30
How Your Side Curtain
Airbags Work ........................... 30
Signaling Turns ................................ 69
Snow Tires ...................................... 232
Sound System ........ 114, 122, 131, 135
Spare Tire
Inflating ....................................... 238
Specifications ............................. 268
Specifications Charts..................... 266
Speed Control ................................. 145
Speed Limiter ......................... 172, 175
Speedometer .................................... 64
SRS, Additional Information........... 23
Additional Safety Precautions .... 33
Airbag Service .............................. 32

VI

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

How the Passenger Airbag Off
Indicator Works ....................... 31
How Your SRS Indicator
Works ........................................ 30
How Your Front Airbags
Works ........................................ 25
How Your Side Airbags
Works ........................................ 28
SRS Components ......................... 23
SRS Indicator.............................. 30, 59
START (Ignition Key Position) ..... 76
Starting the Engine........................ 169
With a Dead Battery ................. 245
Steam Coming from Engine ......... 248
Steering Wheel
Adjustment ................................... 73
Anti-theft Column Lock .............. 76
Stereo Sound
System ................ 114, 122, 131, 135
Sun Visor........................................... 96
Sunglasses Holder ......................... 100
Supplemental Restraint
System................................. 11, 23
Servicing ....................................... 32
SRS Indicator.......................... 30, 59
System Components.................... 23

05/07/01

10:34:51

31SDA630

0292

Index
Synthetic Oil ................................... 205

T

U
Unexpected, Taking Care
of the ........................................... 237
Uniform Tire Quality Grading ..... 269
Unleaded Gasoline......................... 154
Used Oil, How to Dispose of ........ 207

V
Vanity Mirror ................................... 96
Vehicle Capacity Load .................. 165
Vehicle Dimensions....................... 266
Vehicle Identification Number..... 264
Vehicle Stability Assist (VSA)
System..................................... 182
VSA Activation Indicator .... 60, 182
VSA Off Switch .......................... 183
VSA System Indicator ......... 60, 182
Vehicle Storage .............................. 235
VIN .................................................. 264
Viscosity, Oil................................... 205
Voice Control System............ 104, 116
CONTINUED

VII

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

INDEX

Tachometer ...................................... 64
Taking Care of the Unexpected .. 237
Technical Descriptions
DOT Tire Quality Grading ....... 269
Emissions Control Systems ...... 272
Three Way Catalytic
Converter ................................ 273
Temperature Gauge ........................ 65
Tether Anchorage Points ............... 47
Three Way Catalytic Converter ... 273
Time, Setting the ........................... 143
Timing Belt ..................................... 217
Tire Chains ..................................... 232
Tire, How to Change a Flat .......... 239
Tire Labeling .................................. 271
Tires ................................................ 227
Air Pressure ............................... 228
Checking Wear .......................... 229
Compact Spare ........................... 238
DOT Tire Quality Grading ....... 269
Inflation ....................................... 227
Inspection ................................... 228

Replacing .................................... 231
Rotating....................................... 230
Snow ............................................ 232
Specifications ............................. 268
Tools, Tire Changing .................... 239
Towing
A Trailer ...................................... 184
Emergency Wrecker ................. 255
Transmission
Checking Fluid Level,
Automatic ....................... 211, 212
Checking Fluid Level,
Manual .................................... 214
Fluid Selection ........... 211, 213, 214
Identification Number............... 265
Shifting the Automatic .............. 173
Shifting the Manual ................... 170
Treadwear ...................................... 269
Trip Meter ........................................ 65
Trunk................................................. 82
Emergency Opener ..................... 83
Opening the .................................. 82
Open Monitor Light .................... 60
Turn Signals ..................................... 69

05/07/01

10:34:55

31SDA630

0293

Index
W
WARNING, Explanation of .............. ii
Warning Labels, Location of .......... 53
Warranty Coverages ..................... 279
Washer, Windshield
Checking the Fluid Level ......... 208
Operation ...................................... 68
Wheels
Adjusting the Steering ................ 73
Alignment and Balance ............. 229
Compact Spare ........................... 238
Wrench ....................................... 239
Windows
Operating the Power ................... 91
Rear, Defogger ............................ 72
Windshield
Cleaning ........................................ 68
Washers ........................................ 68
Wipers, Windshield
Changing Blades ........................ 225
Operation ...................................... 68
Worn Tires ..................................... 229
Wrecker, Emergency Towing ...... 255

VIII

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

05/07/01

10:35:13

31SDA630

0297

Service Information Summary
Gasoline:
Unleaded gasoline, pump octane
number of 87 or higher.
Fuel Tank Capacity:
17.09 US gal (64.7 )

Manual Transmission Fluid:
Honda Manual Transmission
Fluid preferred, or an SAE 10W-30
or 10W-40 motor oil as a
temporary replacement (see page
214 ).
5-speed manual transmission:

Recommended Engine Oil:
API Premium grade 5W-20
detergent oil (see page 204 ).

Tire Pressure (measured cold):
U.S. VP, SE, EX and EX-L
Canadian DX-G, SE and EX-L
Front:
32 psi (220 kPa , 2.2 kgf/cm )
Rear:
30 psi (210 kPa , 2.1 kgf/cm )

2.0 US qt (1.9 )
6-speed manual transmission:

2.3 US qt (2.2 )

Oil change capacity (including
filter):
4-cylinder models
4.4 US qt (4.2 )
6-cylinder models
4.5 US qt (4.3 )

Power Steering Fluid:
Honda Power Steering Fluid
preferred, or another brand of
power steering fluid as a
temporary replacement. Do not
use ATF (see page 216 ).

Automatic Transmission Fluid:
Honda ATF-Z1 (Automatic
Transmission Fluid) preferred, or
a DEXRON III ATF as a
temporary replacement (see
pages 211 and 212 ).

Brake Fluid:
Honda Heavy Duty Brake Fluid
DOT 3 preferred, or a DOT 3 or
DOT 4 brake fluid as a temporary
replacement (see page 215 ).

I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:

U.S. LX
Front:
30 psi (210 kPa , 2.1 kgf/cm )
Rear:
29 psi (200 kPa , 2.0 kgf/cm )
U.S. LX-V6 and EX-V6
Canadian SE-V6 and EX-V6
Front:
32 psi (220 kPa , 2.2 kgf/cm )
Rear:
29 psi (200 kPa , 2.0 kgf/cm )
Spare Tire Pressure:
60 psi (420 kPa , 4.2 kgf/cm )



Source Exif Data:
File Type                       : PDF
File Type Extension             : pdf
MIME Type                       : application/pdf
PDF Version                     : 1.6
Linearized                      : Yes
Create Date                     : 2013:12:10 13:30:33-08:00
Creator                         : MDXmainindex.doc - Microsoft Word
Modify Date                     : 2015:09:18 12:15:14-05:00
Title                           : 
Has XFA                         : No
XMP Toolkit                     : Adobe XMP Core 5.4-c005 78.147326, 2012/08/23-13:03:03
Metadata Date                   : 2015:09:18 12:15:14-05:00
Creator Tool                    : MDXmainindex.doc - Microsoft Word
Format                          : application/pdf
Document ID                     : uuid:32f5d7af-c437-4697-afd2-31bd88fc5dfc
Instance ID                     : uuid:f29c7e98-3274-4b61-91fc-fc602e99886c
Producer                        : Adobe Acrobat Pro 10.1.3
Page Count                      : 292
EXIF Metadata provided by EXIF.tools

Navigation menu